US20220241396A1 - Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses - Google Patents

Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20220241396A1
US20220241396A1 US17/578,939 US202217578939A US2022241396A1 US 20220241396 A1 US20220241396 A1 US 20220241396A1 US 202217578939 A US202217578939 A US 202217578939A US 2022241396 A1 US2022241396 A1 US 2022241396A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
residue
virus
venus
influenza virus
viral
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US17/578,939
Inventor
Yoshihiro Kawaoka
Yuri Furusawa
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation
Original Assignee
Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation filed Critical Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation
Priority to US17/578,939 priority Critical patent/US20220241396A1/en
Assigned to WISCONSIN ALUMNI RESEARCH FOUNDATION reassignment WISCONSIN ALUMNI RESEARCH FOUNDATION ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: Furusawa, Yuri, KAWAOKA, YOSHIHIRO
Publication of US20220241396A1 publication Critical patent/US20220241396A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/12Viral antigens
    • A61K39/145Orthomyxoviridae, e.g. influenza virus
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • A61P31/16Antivirals for RNA viruses for influenza or rhinoviruses
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K14/00Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K14/005Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from viruses
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N7/00Viruses; Bacteriophages; Compositions thereof; Preparation or purification thereof
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2760/00MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA ssRNA viruses negative-sense
    • C12N2760/00011Details
    • C12N2760/16011Orthomyxoviridae
    • C12N2760/16111Influenzavirus A, i.e. influenza A virus
    • C12N2760/16121Viruses as such, e.g. new isolates, mutants or their genomic sequences
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2760/00MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA ssRNA viruses negative-sense
    • C12N2760/00011Details
    • C12N2760/16011Orthomyxoviridae
    • C12N2760/16111Influenzavirus A, i.e. influenza A virus
    • C12N2760/16122New viral proteins or individual genes, new structural or functional aspects of known viral proteins or genes
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2760/00MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA ssRNA viruses negative-sense
    • C12N2760/00011Details
    • C12N2760/16011Orthomyxoviridae
    • C12N2760/16111Influenzavirus A, i.e. influenza A virus
    • C12N2760/16131Uses of virus other than therapeutic or vaccine, e.g. disinfectant
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2760/00MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA ssRNA viruses negative-sense
    • C12N2760/00011Details
    • C12N2760/16011Orthomyxoviridae
    • C12N2760/16111Influenzavirus A, i.e. influenza A virus
    • C12N2760/16134Use of virus or viral component as vaccine, e.g. live-attenuated or inactivated virus, VLP, viral protein
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2760/00MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA ssRNA viruses negative-sense
    • C12N2760/00011Details
    • C12N2760/16011Orthomyxoviridae
    • C12N2760/16111Influenzavirus A, i.e. influenza A virus
    • C12N2760/16141Use of virus, viral particle or viral elements as a vector
    • C12N2760/16143Use of virus, viral particle or viral elements as a vector viral genome or elements thereof as genetic vector

Definitions

  • Influenza A virus is a respiratory pathogen that causes annual epidemics and sporadic pandemics (Wright et al., 2013). Moreover, highly pathogenic avian H5N1 and the recently emerged H7N9 influenza viruses have caused an appreciable number of human infections with high mortality rates (Watanabe et al., 2013; Zhang et al., 2013). Influenza viruses infect respiratory epithelial cells and alveolar macrophages in mammalian hosts (Yu et al., 2010).
  • the host immune system recognizes the RNA genome of influenza viruses via cytosolic sensors (Diebold et al., 2004; Pichlmair et al., 2006), which trigger innate immune responses that lead to the production of type I interferons (IFNs) and proinflammatory cytokines and chemokines (Honda and Taniguchi, 2006).
  • Type I IFNs upregulate the production of antiviral proteins including myxovirus resistance (Mx), oligoadenylate synthetase (OAS), and interferon-stimulated gene 15 (ISG15) (Garcia-Sastre et al., 2011).
  • Dysregulation of the innate immune responses to influenza virus infection causes lung pathology mediated by infiltrating immune cells, including macrophages and neutrophils (Heron et al., 2008; Perrone et al., 2008). Although several studies have addressed host responses to influenza virus infections (Fakuyama and Kawaoka, 2011), the mechanisms of influenza virus-induced pathology are still not fully understood.
  • viruses have been generated that expressed a fluorescent reporter protein (Kittel et al., 2004; Shinya et al., 2004).
  • these viruses were significantly attenuated (Kittel et al., 2004; Shinya et al., 2004) and may not accurately reflect natural infections.
  • Manicassamy et al. (2010) generated a GFP-expressing influenza virus, which they used to assess the route of antigen presentation upon influenza virus infection (Helft et al., 2012).
  • the GFP gene was not stably maintained during replication in mouse lung or cultured cells (Manicassamy et al., 2010).
  • HPAI Highly pathogenic avian influenza viruses
  • H5N1 subtype continue to evolve in nature, threatening animal and public health.
  • These viruses were first identified in Guangdong province in China in 1996 (Li et al., 2006), and have since been found in over 63 countries in multiple avian species, repeatedly infecting mammals such as pigs and humans (Li et al., 2010; Neumann et al., 2010).
  • WHO World health organization
  • influenza viruses such as H7N9 and H10N8 virus
  • H7N9 and H10N8 virus have spontaneously appeared and sporadically infected humans causing fatal outcomes (Chen et al., 2014; Li et al., 2013) (http://www.who.int).
  • the current threat from influenza viruses reminds us of the urgent need to gain a thorough understanding of their pathogenic mechanism in order to develop more effective strategies for control, including dynamic processes of influenza virus infection and virus-target cells in vivo remain unclear.
  • the present disclosure relates to mutations in influenza virus viral segment(s) that increase genetic; stability, for instance, of an additional, non-influenza viral gene, such as a “heterologous” gene sequence that is inserted into one of the viral segments, e.g., fused to an intact or modified (for example, truncated or internally deleted) viral protein coding region, or that is present on an additional viral segment.
  • an additional, non-influenza viral gene such as a “heterologous” gene sequence that is inserted into one of the viral segments, e.g., fused to an intact or modified (for example, truncated or internally deleted) viral protein coding region, or that is present on an additional viral segment.
  • one or more of the mutations may be employed to enhance the stability of influenza viruses that are not augmented with heterologous gene sequences.
  • the heterologous gene sequence is a marker gene, e.g., a fluorescent protein gene such as one for GFP, BFP, RFP, or YFP, a luciferase gene, a beta-glucuronidase gene, or beta-lactamase gene.
  • the heterologous sequence is for a prophylactic gene product.
  • the heterologous sequence encodes a therapeutic gene product.
  • influenza viruses expressing fluorescent proteins of different colors were generated. Viruses containing the foreign matter gene were passaged. Upon adaptation to mice, stable expression of the fluorescent proteins in infected animals allowed their detection by different types of microscopy and by flow cytometry.
  • the use of fluorescent influenza viruses, each of which stably expresses one of four different fluorescent proteins, allows for simultaneous monitoring and live imaging Using these viruses, several studies were performed to demonstrate the versatility of these viruses. For example, this system was used to analyze the progression of viral spread in mouse lungs, for live imaging of virus-infected cells, and for differential gene expression studies in virus antigen-positive and -negative live cells in the lungs of Color-flu-infected mice.
  • a recombinant virus has one or more stabilizing mutations, e.g., one or more substitutions in one or more influenza virus proteins that enhance the stability or replication (for instance, enhance the titer) of the recombinant virus with the one or more substitutions relative to a corresponding virus without the one or more substitutions (a parental virus) and/or one or more substitutions in one or more influenza virus proteins that enhance the stability or replication of a heterologous gene sequence present on one of the viral segments in the recombinant virus relative to a corresponding virus without the one or more substitutions that has the heterologous gene sequence in the respective viral segment and/or one or more substitutions in one or more influenza virus proteins that enhance the stability or replication of a heterologous gene sequence that is present on an additional viral segment in the recombinant virus relative to a corresponding virus without the one or more substitution and that has the additional viral segment with the heterologous gene sequence.
  • the one or more substitutions include but are not limited to substitutions in any of influenza PA, PA-X, PB1, PB1-F2, PB2, NP, NS1, NS2, M1, M2, NA, and/or HA (e.g., a HA of influenza A virus), substitutions encoded in the corresponding viral segments therefor (PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and/or HA), or a combination of substitutions in any one of those influenza virus proteins or genes, or a combination of one or more substitutions in two or more of those proteins or genes.
  • substitutions in any of influenza PA, PA-X, PB1, PB1-F2, PB2, NP, NS1, NS2, M1, M2, NA, and/or HA e.g., a HA of influenza A virus
  • substitutions encoded in the corresponding viral segments therefor PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and/or HA
  • the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the PA protein, e.g., a substitution for glutamine at position 180, for threonine at position 200, or for arginine at position 443 in PA (which is located on the protein surface) that enhances, for example, RNA replication, PA proteolytic activity and/or interaction with one or more viral or cellular proteins.
  • the substitution for arginine at position 443 in PA is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for arginine at position 443 in PA is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for glutamine at position 180 in PA is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for glutamine at position 180 in PA is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for threonine at position 200 in PA is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for threonine at position 200 in PA is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the PB2 protein, e.g., a substitution for valine at position 25, a substitution for asparagine at position 540, and/or for glutamic acid at position 712 in PB2 that, for example, enhances polymerase activity, interaction with MAVS (for position 25) and/or protein folding or stability (for position 712).
  • the substitution for valine at position 25 in PB2 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for valine at position 25 in PB2 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for asparagine at position 540 in PB2 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for asparagine at position 540 in PB2 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamic acid at position 712 in PB2 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamic acid at position 712 in PB2 is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the PB1 protein, e.g., a substitution for valine at position 149, for lysine at position 737, for glutamic acid at position 684, and/or for aspartic acid at position 685, in PB1 (which may be located on the protein surface) that, for instance, alter polymerase or endonuclease activity.
  • the substitution for lysine at position 737 in PB1 is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for lysine at position 737 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for valine at position 149 in PB1 is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for valine at position 149 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for glutamic acid at position 684 in PB1 is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for glutamic acid at position 684 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for aspartic acid at position 685 in PB1 is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for aspartic acid at position 685 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication are in the NS1 protein, e.g., a substitution for proline at position 167 in NS1 which may alter interaction with cellular proteins.
  • the substitution for proline at position 167 in NS1 is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for proline at position 167 in NS1 is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the HA protein, e.g., a substitution for threonine at position 380 in HA (which is in an alpha helix of HA-2).
  • the substitution for threonine at position 380 in HA is a conservative substitution.
  • the substitution for threonine at position 380 in HA is a non-conservative substitution.
  • the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H.
  • the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R.
  • the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G.
  • the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D.
  • the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T.
  • viruses may be employed as vaccines or as gene delivery vectors.
  • influenza cDNA e.g., influenza A (e.g., any influenza A gene including any of the 18 HA or 11 NA subtypes), B or C DNA (see Fields Virology (Fields et al. (eds.), Lippincott, Williams and Wickens (2006), which is specifically incorporated by reference herein).
  • influenza A e.g., any influenza A gene including any of the 18 HA or 11 NA subtypes
  • B or C DNA see Fields Virology (Fields et al. (eds.), Lippincott, Williams and Wickens (2006), which is specifically incorporated by reference herein).
  • PB1, PB2, PA, NP, M, and NS encode proteins having at least 80%, e.g., 90°/c, 92%, 95%, 97%, 98%, or 99%, including any integer between 80 and 99, contiguous amino acid sequence identity to, a polypeptide encoded by one of SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15, although the disclosed positions and substitutions in viral proteins may be made in a viral segment from any influenza virus isolate or may be used to select viral segments with specified residues at the one or more disclosed positions.
  • PB1, PB2, PA, NP, M, and NS encode proteins that are having at least 80%, e.g., 90%, 92%, 95%, 97%, 98%, or 99%, including any integer between 80 and 99, contiguous amino acid sequence identity to, a polypeptide encoded by one of SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15.
  • influenza virus polypeptide has one or more, for instance, 2, 5, 10, 15, 20 or more, conservative amino acids substitutions, e.g., conservative substitutions of up to 10% or 20% of 2, 5, 10, 15, 20 or more, of a combination of conservative and non-conservative amino acids substitutions, e.g., conservative substitutions of up to 10% or 20% of the residues, or relative to a polypeptide encoded by one of SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15, and has a characteristic residue as described herein that provides for stability.
  • conservative amino acids substitutions e.g., conservative substitutions of up to 10% or 20% of 2, 5, 10, 15, 20 or more
  • a combination of conservative and non-conservative amino acids substitutions e.g., conservative substitutions of up to 10% or 20% of the residues, or relative to a polypeptide encoded by one of SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15, and has a characteristic residue as described herein that provides for stability.
  • a recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in a recombinant virus, such as a reassortant virus, having one or more stabilizing mutations in one or more influenza virus proteins. For example, a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 200 that is not threonine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment
  • the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V. In one embodiment, the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R. In one embodiment, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L. In one embodiment, the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N. In one embodiment, the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G. In one embodiment, the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D.
  • the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H.
  • the residue at position 167 in NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T.
  • the residue at position 380 in HA is A, I, V, L or G.
  • the influenza virus of the disclosure is a recombinant influenza virus having two or more of selected amino acid residues at specified positions in one or more of PA, PB1, PB2, HA, and/or NS1.
  • the recombinant reassortant influenza virus has a lysine or histidine at position 443 in PA, a histidine or arginine at position 737 in PB1, a leucine, isoleucine, threonine, alanine or glycine at position 25 in PB2 and/or an aspartic acid, histidine, arginine, lysine or asparagine at position 712 in PB2; a leucine, alanine, valine, isoleucine, or glycine at position 380 in HA, or serine, cysteine, methionine, alanine, valine, glycine, isoleucine or leucine at position 167 in NS1.
  • a recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure having an extra viral segment with a heterologous gene sequence (a “9 segment” virus) which virus has enhanced stability and/or replication may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in the recombinant virus having one or more of the stabilizing mutations in an influenza virus protein.
  • a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected;
  • a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected;
  • a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected;
  • a PB2 viral segment encoding a PB2 with a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid may be selected;
  • a NS viral segment enclosing a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline may be selected; or any combination thereof.
  • the extra viral segment may be derived from any of the naturally occurring viral segments.
  • the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H.
  • the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R.
  • the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G.
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H.
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V.
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L.
  • the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N.
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D. In one embodiment, the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T.
  • the heterologous gene sequence may be of length that results in the viral segment with that heterologous gene sequence having a length that is up to 4 kb, 4.2 kb, 4.5 kb, 4.7 kb, 5 kb, 5.2 kb, 5.5 kb, 5.7 kb or 6 kb in length.
  • the heterologous gene in the extra viral segment replaces influenza virus protein coding sequences (e.g., there is a deletion of influenza virus coding sequences without deleting encapsidation (incorporation) sequences in coding sequences that are linked to encapsidation sequences in non-coding sequences at one or both ends of the viral segment).
  • the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is in genomic orientation.
  • the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is fused in frame to N-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences.
  • the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is fused in frame to C-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences.
  • the heterologous gene may encode a RNA, e.g., a microRNA, or a protein, e.g., a gene product that is prophylactic or therapeutic.
  • the gene product is an antigen from a different influenza virus isolate, or an antigen from a bacteria, a virus other than influenza virus, a parasite, or a fungus.
  • a recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure having a heterologous gene sequence in one of the eight viral segments (an “8 segment” virus) with enhanced stability and/or replication may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in the recombinant virus having one or more of the stabilizing mutations in an influenza virus protein.
  • a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected;
  • a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected;
  • a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected;
  • a PB2 viral segment encoding a PB2 with a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid may be selected;
  • a NS viral segment enclosing a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline may be selected; or any combination thereof.
  • the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H.
  • the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R.
  • the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G.
  • the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D.
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H.
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V.
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L.
  • the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N.
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H.
  • the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T.
  • a recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure having a heterologous gene sequence in one of the influenza virus viral segments that also lacks a viral segment may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in the recombinant virus having one or more of the stabilizing mutations in an influenza virus protein.
  • a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected;
  • a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected;
  • a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected;
  • a PB2 viral segment encoding a PB2 with a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid may be selected;
  • a NS viral segment enclosing a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline may be selected; or any combination thereof.
  • the viral segment that is omitted may be any one of the naturally occurring viral segments and optionally the encoded protein is provided in trans.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PA viral segment, or the PA protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the PB1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PB2 viral segment, or the PB2 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PB2 viral segment, or the PB2 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PA viral segment, or the PA protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PA viral segment, or the PA protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the PB1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L.
  • the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the PB1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the P protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB2 viral segment, or the PB2 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a NS viral segment, or the NS1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T.
  • the heterologous gene sequence may be of length that results in the viral segment with that heterologous gene sequence having a length that is up to 4 kb, 4.2 kb, 4.5 kb, 4.7 kb, 5 kb, 5.2 kb, 5.5 kb, 5.7 kb or 6 kb in length.
  • the heterologous gene replaces influenza virus protein coding sequences (e.g., there is a deletion of influenza virus coding sequences without deleting encapsidation (incorporation) sequences in coding sequences that are linked to encapsidation sequences in non-coding sequences at one or both ends of the viral segment).
  • the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is in genomic orientation.
  • the heterologous gene sequence is fused in frame to N-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is fused in frame to C-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences.
  • the heterologous gene may encode a RNA, e.g., a microRNA, or a protein, e.g., a gene product that is prophylactic or therapeutic.
  • the gene product is an antigen from a different influenza virus isolate, or an antigen from a bacteria, a virus other than influenza virus, a parasite, or a fungus.
  • the heterologous gene sequence may be inserted into any viral segment.
  • the heterologous gene sequence may be of length that results in the viral segment with that heterologous gene sequence having a length that is up to 4 kb, 4.2 kb, 4.5 kb, 4.7 kb, 5 kb, 5.2 kb, 5.5 kb, 5.7 kb or 6 kb in length.
  • the heterologous gene replaces internal influenza virus sequences in the viral segment.
  • the insertion of a heterologous gene sequence may result in a “knock-out” of the respective influenza virus gene product and to prepare such a virus, influenza virus protein(s) may be provided in trans to complement that type of mutation.
  • the heterologous gene sequences are in addition to influenza virus coding sequences in the viral segment.
  • the heterologous gene sequence is fused in frame to N-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences.
  • the heterologous gene in is fused in frame to C-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences.
  • the heterologous gene may encode a RNA or a protein, e.g., a gene product that is prophylactic or therapeutic.
  • the gene product is an antigen from a different influenza virus isolate, an antigen from a bacteria, a virus other than influenza virus, a parasite, or a fungus.
  • the heterologous gene sequence is in the NA viral segment.
  • the heterologous gene sequence is in the HA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the M viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the NP viral segment, e.g., see Liu et al., 2012; Wang et al. 2010; Anot et al., 2010; Dos Santos Afonso et al., 2005). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the PA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the PB2 viral segment.
  • the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment (see, e.g., Avilov et al. 2012).
  • the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NS coding sequence in the NS viral segment (Manicassamy et al. 2010). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NS2 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the HA coding sequence in the HA viral segment.
  • the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NA coding sequence in the NA viral segment (see, e.g., Perez et al. 2004). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the M1 coding sequence in the M viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the M2 coding sequence in the M viral segment (see, e.g., Wei et al. 2011).
  • a vaccine comprising the recombinant virus of the disclosure, e.g., a live attenuated vaccine or where the recombinant virus is cold adapted, one or more vectors comprising one or more viral segments with one or more of the disclosed substitutions, as well as methods of making and using the recombinant virus.
  • the vector for vRNA production comprises a promoter such as a RNA polymerase I promoter, a RNA polymerase II promoter, a RNA polymerase III promoter, a T3 promoter or a T7 promoter.
  • the method includes serially passaging an isolate of an influenza virus in an individual host organism, and identifying individual viruses with the altered property and optionally molecularly characterizing the individual viruses.
  • each member of the set encoding a distinct optically detectable marker, e.g., the open reading frame of which is fused to the open reading frame of an influenza virus protein, the open reading frame of which is on a ninth viral segment for influenza A or B viruses, or the open reading frame of which replaces at least a portion of one of the viral protein coding regions.
  • a distinct optically detectable marker e.g., the open reading frame of which is fused to the open reading frame of an influenza virus protein, the open reading frame of which is on a ninth viral segment for influenza A or B viruses, or the open reading frame of which replaces at least a portion of one of the viral protein coding regions.
  • one of the members includes a luminescent protein gene, e.g., a luciferase gene, a fluorescent protein gene, for instance, green fluorescent protein gene, yellow fluorescent protein gene, or red fluorescent protein gene, photoprotein genes such as Aequorin photoprotein gene or obelin photoprotein gene, chloramphenical acetyltransferase gene, a phosphatase gene such as alkaline phosphatase gene, a peroxidase gene such as horseradish peroxidase gene, beta-galactosidase gene, beta-lactamase gene or beta-glucuronidase gene.
  • a luminescent protein gene e.g., a luciferase gene, a fluorescent protein gene, for instance, green fluorescent protein gene, yellow fluorescent protein gene, or red fluorescent protein gene
  • photoprotein genes such as Aequorin photoprotein gene or obelin photoprotein gene, chloramphenical acetyltransferase gene, a phosphata
  • FIGS. 1A-1G Characteristics of mouse-adapted Venus ⁇ PR8 in mice.
  • A-F Four B6 mice per group were intranasally inoculated with WT ⁇ PR8, WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8, or MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8. Body weight and survival of mice were monitored for 14 days.
  • G Lungs of animals infected with 10 4 PFU of PR8 or MA ⁇ Venus PR8 (three mice per group) were harvested at days 3, 5, and 7 p.i. Virus titers were analyzed by use of a plaque assay in MDCK cells.
  • FIGS. 2A-2C Distribution of Color-flu viruses in lungs.
  • Lung tissues were harvested from B6 mice at days 3 and 5 p.i. with Color-flu viruses (105 PFU of MA ⁇ eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry ⁇ PR8).
  • the open reading frame (ORF) of the NS1 gene without a stop codon was fused with the N-terminus of fluorescent reporter genes (Venus, eCFP, eGFP, and mCherry) via a sequence encoding the protein linker GSGG.
  • the fluorescent genes are followed by a sequence encoding the GSG linker, a foot-and-mouth virus protease 2A autoproteolytic site with 57 nucleotides from porcine teschovirus-1, and by the ORF of NEP.
  • silent mutations were introduced into the endogenous splice acceptor site of the NS1 ORF to prevent splicing.
  • Whole-mount images of transparent lung tissues were obtained by using a fluorescent stereomicroscope.
  • B, C B6 mice were intranasally inoculated with a mixture of MA ⁇ eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry-PR8 (2.5 ⁇ 10 4 PFU per strain). Scale bar, 5 mm.
  • (B) The sections of lungs at days 2 and 5 p.i. were analyzed by using an inverted fluorescence microscope with a Nuance FX multispectral imaging system with InForm software. Scale bar, 100 ⁇ m.
  • (C) Enlarged images of the indicated area in (B) were unmixed and separated into autofluorescence (AF), eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry fluorescence. Arrows in the merged image indicate cells infected with different color variants of Color-flu viruses.
  • FIGS. 3A-3K Analysis of macrophage infiltration.
  • A-D Lung tissues were harvested from PBS-inoculated mice (mock) or mice infected with 105 PFU of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 at day 2 p.i., and tissues were fixed and processed for histological analysis. Sections were incubated with PE-anti-Mac3 antibody to detect macrophages (red) and counterstained with Hoechst dye (blue) to visualize nuclei. The fluorescent signal of the Venus protein is shown in green. The scale bar represents 200 ⁇ m.
  • E-H Kinetics of the interaction between virus infected cells and lung macrophages.
  • J Differentially expressed (DE) transcripts were identified by comparing gene expression levels in naive macrophages with those in Venus(+) macrophages from infected mice. Likewise, gene expression levels were compared for naive macrophages and Venus( ⁇ ) macrophages obtained from infected mice.
  • DE transcripts were organized by hierarchical clustering and each cluster was analyzed for enriched biological functions.
  • a heat map of the clustered transcripts for each condition is displayed (a color key is shown at the top of the panel), and the different clusters are illustrated by the color bar on the left of the heat map.
  • Enriched annotations for each cluster are listed to the left of each cluster, with the enrichment score for each annotation in parentheses.
  • the blue line in the heat map illustrates fold changes of DE transcripts when comparing Venus(+) with Venus( ⁇ ) macrophages. A shift of the blue line to the left indicates that the DE transcript is more highly expressed in Venus(+) macrophages, whereas a shift to the right indicates that the DE transcript is more highly expressed in Venus( ⁇ ) macrophages.
  • K This panel shows a heat map comparing expression levels of type I interferons (IFNs) between Venus(+) and Venus( ⁇ ) macrophages. A color key is shown at the bottom of the panel.
  • NS denotes comparisons that were not statistically significant between Venus( ⁇ ) cells from infected animals and naive macrophages from uninfected animals.
  • FIGS. 4A-4E Characterization of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ HPAI virus.
  • A Four B6 mice per group were intranasally inoculated with MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ HPAI virus. Mouse body weight and survival were monitored for 14 days.
  • B Lungs, spleens, kidneys, and brains were harvested from B6 mice at day 3 p.i. with 105 PFU of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ HPAI virus.
  • C, D Lung tissues were harvested from B6 mice at day 1 and day 2 p.i.
  • FIG. 5 Virus yield of various viruses.
  • FIGS. 6A-6D Virulence of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus and RG ⁇ MA virus in mice. Groups of four mice were intranasally infected with WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus at doses of 101 to 105 PFU or with RG ⁇ MA virus at doses of 10 0 to 10 5 PFU, and their body weight changes (A-C) and survival (B-D) were monitored for two weeks.
  • FIG. 7 Venus expression of various H5N1 viruses in MDCK cells.
  • MDCK cells were infected with Venus ⁇ H5N1-related viruses, and at 24 hpi the Venus expression of each virus plaque was observed by using fluorescent microscopy (Axio Observer.Z1, Zeiss). A representative image of each virus is shown.
  • FIG. 8 Venus expression of various H5N1 viruses in mouse lung.
  • Groups of three mice were intranasally infected with 105 PFU (50 ⁇ l) of virus.
  • the mice were euthanized on day 2 p.i., and their lungs were collected and fixed in 4% PFA and then embedded in O.C.T Compound.
  • the frozen tissues were cut into 5- ⁇ m slices and then stained with Hoechst 33342.
  • Venus signal was detected by using the Nikon confocal microscope system A1 + . Blue represents nuclei stained by Hoechst 33342; green represents Venus expression.
  • FIG. 9 Genotypes of Venus ⁇ H5N1-related reassortants and their virulence in mice.
  • the colors indicate the origins of the viral segments: blue, WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus; red, MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus.
  • MLD 50 values were determined by inoculating groups of four mice with 10-fold serial dilutions contain 10 0 to 105 PFU of virus in a 50- ⁇ L volume and were calculated by using the method of Reed and Muench (30).
  • FIG. 10 Growth kinetics of reassortants in MDCK cells. MDCK cells were infected with virus at an MOI of 0.0001, and culture supernatants were collected at the indicated times and then titrated in MDCK cells. The reported values are means ⁇ standard deviations (SD) from two independent experiments. *, P ⁇ 0.01 compared with that of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus-infected cells.
  • FIG. 11 Polymerase activity of different RNP combinations derived from the WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 and MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 viruses.
  • 293 cells were transfected in triplicate with a luciferase reporter plasmid and an internal control plasmid, together with plasmids expressing PB1, PB2, PA, and NP from either WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 or MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus. Segments derived from WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus are shown in white, whereas those derived from MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus are in green. Cells were incubated at 37° C.
  • FIG. 12A Venus-NS and deleted NS segments of Venus ⁇ H5N1-related reassortants. Viruses were passaged five times in MDCK cells and the vRNAs from the fifth passages were extracted by using a QIAamp® Viral RNA Mini Kit (QIAGEN). The respective NS segments were then amplified by using PCR with NS-specific primers and run on an agarose gel.
  • QIAamp® Viral RNA Mini Kit QIAGEN
  • Lane 1 WT+MA ⁇ NS; lane 2, WT+MA ⁇ M; lane 3, WT+MA ⁇ NA; lane 4, WT+MA ⁇ PA; lane 5, WT+MA ⁇ PB1; lane 6, WT+MA ⁇ PB2; lane 7, WT+MA ⁇ (PB2+PA); lane 8, WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1; lane 9, RG ⁇ MA; lane 10, PR8; and lane 11, 1-kb DNA marker.
  • FIG. 12B Schematic of deleted viruses.
  • FIG. 13 High expression of Venus reassortants in mouse lung.
  • FIG. 14 Comparison of the growth capabilities of mutant viruses in MDCK cells.
  • MDCK cells were infected at a MOI of 0.001 with PR8, NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT, NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA, and mutant NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 viruses that possess amino acid substitutions found in NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus.
  • Virus titers were determined every 12 hours by means of plaque assays. Results are expressed as the mean titer (log 10 [PFU/ml]) ⁇ standard deviation.
  • FIG. 15 Body weight changes and survival rates for mice infected with viruses carrying Venus. Four mice per group were intranasally infected with 10 3 , 10 4 and 10 5 PFU of each NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 virus. Body weights were measured and survival rates were monitored for 14 days after infection.
  • FIGS. 16A-16B Virus titers in mouse lung.
  • Nine mice per group were intranasally infected with 103 PFU of PR8 (A) or the respective NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 virus (B).
  • Three mice per group were euthanized on days 3, 5, and 7 after infection and their lungs collected to determine virus titers.
  • Virus titers were determined by means of plaque assays. Results are expressed as the mean of the titer (log 10 PFU/g) ⁇ standard deviation. Statistical significance was calculated by using the Tukey-Kramer method. Asterisks indicate significant differences from titers from mice infected with PR8 or NS1 ⁇ Venus WT virus (P ⁇ 0.05).
  • ND Not detected (detection limit, 5 PFU/lung).
  • FIG. 17 The stability of Venus expression by NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus in vitro and in vivo.
  • the positive rate of Venus expression was examined in MDCK cells and in mouse lung.
  • Left panel MDCK cells were infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus at an MOI of 0.001, and supernatants were collected every 24 hours. The positive rate of Venus expression was estimated by dividing the number of plaques that expressed Venus by the total number of plaques.
  • Middle panel NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus was serially passaged in MDCK cells five times and the positive rates of Venus expression were estimated.
  • Right panel Nine mice were infected with 103 PFU of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus. Three mice were euthanized at each time point and plaque assays were performed using lung homogenates. The positive rates of Venus expression were estimated as described above.
  • FIGS. 18A-18G Comparison of Venus expression in cells infected with each NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 virus.
  • A-B Venus protein expression in cells infected with each NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 virus was detected by means of western blotting. MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1. Twelve hours after infection, virus-infected cells were lysed and western blotting was performed. An anti-GFP antibody was used to detect Venus protein, and M1 protein was detected as a control. The bands appeared at approximately 27 kDa were shown in M1 panel. Representative results of two independent experiments are shown.
  • C-F Observation of Venus expression by use of confocal microscopy.
  • MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1. Twelve hours after infection, cells were fixed, and Venus expression was observed. Representative results of two independent experiments are shown. Indicated viruses were used to infect MDCK cells (MOI of 1) and confocal microscopy was performed 12 hours later.
  • G HEK293 cells were infected with viral protein expression plasmids for NP, PA, PB1 and PB2 or PB-2 ⁇ E712D, together with a plasmid expressing a vRNA encoding firefly luciferase.
  • FIG. 19 Polykaryon formation by HEK293 cells infected with wild-type PR8 or PR8 that possesses the HA ⁇ T380A mutation after exposure to low pH buffer. The threshold for membrane fusion was examined at a pH range of 5.5-5.9. HEK293 cells were infected with PR8 or PR8 that possesses the HA ⁇ T380A substitution. Eighteen hours after infection, HA on the cell surface was digested with TPCK-trypsin, and exposure to the indicated pH buffer. After fixation with methanol, the cells were stained with Giemsa's solution. Representative pictures are shown.
  • FIG. 20 Time-course observation of Venus-expressing cells in transparent lungs. Venus-expressing cells in whole lung lobe were observed. Three mice per group were intranasally infected with NS1-Venus PR8 MA, NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT or PR8 virus and lungs were collected on the indicated days. Mock-treated lungs served as a negative control. To image Venus-expressing cells deeper, lung samples were treated with SCALEVIEW A2, which make samples transparent, and were separated into each lobe and observed by using a stereo fluorescence microscope. After imaging the whole lung lobe (intact), samples were dissected to exposure the bronchi (cut).
  • FIGS. 21A-21B Analysis of Venus expression in CC10 + cells and SP-C + cells in lungs.
  • Lung sections from mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus were stained with several antibodies specific for the epithelial cells in the lung. Mice were infected with 10 4 PFU of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 and 5 days post-infection.
  • FIGS. 22A-22E Flow cytometric analysis of Venus-positive cells in specific cell types of the lung. Venus-positive cells in the indicated cell types were analyzed by using flow cytometry. Mice were infected with 105 PFU of PR8 or NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 and 5 days post-infection. Single cell suspensions were stained with antibodies.
  • A Representative dot plot for CD45 + live cells from the lung of mice inoculated with PBS are shown.
  • B, C Total numbers of each specific cell species at the indicated time points are shown. Results are expressed as the mean cell numbers per lung ⁇ standard deviation.
  • CD45 + and via-probe ⁇ cells were analyzed for monocytes and alveolar macrophages.
  • D, E The numbers of Venus-positive cells in cells defined in A and B at the indicated time points are shown. Results are expressed as the mean cell numbers ⁇ standard deviation.
  • AM alveolar macrophage.
  • FIGS. 23A-23B Sorting strategy to collect Venus-positive and Venus-negative cells in the F4/80 + population. Mice were infected with 10 5 PFU of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 days post-infection. Single cell suspensions were stained with a set of antibodies. Lungs from mice inoculated with PBS were similarly stained to confirm the autofluorescence of alveolar macrophages.
  • A Representative dot plots showing the gating strategy to collect Venus-positive and -negative cells in a population of CD45 + , via-probe ⁇ F4/80 + cells. The Venus-positive gate was shown not to include alveolar macrophages.
  • FIGS. 24A-24D Genes differentially expressed between Venus-positive and -negative F4/80 + cells. Mice were infected with 10 5 PFU of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 days post-infection. Single cell suspensions were stained in the same manner as described in FIG. 10 . Venus-positive and -negative cells were separately harvested by using FACSAria II and subjected to microarray analysis. F4/80 + cells isolated from the lungs of mice inoculated with PBS were used as a control.
  • a total of 633 genes were selected by student's T test (P ⁇ 0.05) and by filtering the genes whose expression changed at least 4.0-fold between the Venus-positive and -negative groups from the genes whose expression changed at least 2.0-fold from the level of the PBS group.
  • B These selected genes were functionally annotated by using Gene Ontology (GO) grouping. Statistical significance were determined by using Fisher's exact test (P ⁇ 0.01).
  • C Hierarchical analysis of genes annotated in “cytokine activity” enriched by genes that were significantly differentially expressed between Venus-positive and -negative F4/80 + cells.
  • D Hierarchical analysis of genes annotated in “response to wounding” enriched by genes that were significantly differentially expressed between Venus-positive and -negative F4/80 + cells.
  • FIGS. 25A-25M Exemplary parental sequences for PR8HG and the Cambridge strain of PR8 (SEQ ID Nos: 1-19).
  • FIG. 26 Schematic of fusion protein comprising a heterologous protein.
  • FIG. 27 Schematic of mutations in polymerase complex proteins that stabilize heterologous gene products mapped on the structure of the complex (PDB ID:4WSB).
  • FIGS. 28A-28C A) Schematic structure of the eight viral RNA segments contained in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8. 2A, protease 2A autoproteolytic site. (B) Each virus was passaged in MDCK cells. The proportion of Venus-expressing plaques in virus stocks from different passages was determined in MDCK cells by using fluorescence microscopy. (C) The virus stocks from different passages were titrated by use of plaque assays in MDCK cells.
  • FIGS. 29A-29B Effect of PB2 ⁇ E712D on the mutation rate.
  • A Each virus was passaged five times in MDCK cells, and the mutations introduced into each segment during the passages were counted.
  • B The mutation number per nucleotide in each segment was calculated, and the mean values for all eight segments are shown.
  • FIGS. 30A-30F RNA and protein expression in infected cells.
  • a to C MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1. The relative expression levels of IFN- ⁇ mRNA (A), NS vRNA (B), and NP vRNA (C) were determined by quantitative real-time PCR at 9 h postinfection.
  • D The NS vRNA/NP vRNA ratio was calculated.
  • E MDCK cells were infected with WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 (WT) or Venus ⁇ PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D (712) at an MOI of 1. Cells were lysed at the indicated time points, and the expression of NS1, NP, and ⁇ -actin was detected by Western blotting.
  • FIGS. 31A-31C Internal deletions occurred in the NS segment of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8.
  • A Schematic sequence of the NS segment in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 viruses that lost Venus expression after serial passages in MDCK cells. Selected examples are shown.
  • B The procedure for the coinfection experiment is illustrated. The synonymous mutation was introduced into the 3′ or 5′ region of the NS segment of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8. The viruses were then used to coinfect MDCK cells. Viruses not expressing Venus were plaque purified, and the sequences of their NS segments were analyzed.
  • C Examples of the sequences of the NS segment of Venus-negative viruses obtained after coinfection experiments. The red “X” indicates an introduced synonymous mutation.
  • FIGS. 32A-32D Additional mutations that stabilizes the Venus gene inserted into the NS segment.
  • A Identified amino acid mutations were mapped onto the influenza polymerase complex (PDB ID 4WSB).
  • B Polymerase internal tunnels (shown as yellow tubes). The vRNA promoter binds to the polymerase, and the template vRNA enters the polymerase complex. The template vRNA passes through the active site, where RNA synthesis occurs, and then leaves via the template exit. The RNA products synthesized at the active site, leave via the product exit.
  • C Each mutant Venus ⁇ PR8 virus was passaged four times in MDCK cells, and the proportion of Venus-expressing plaques after passaging was determined in MDCK cells by using fluorescence microscopy.
  • D Percentages of influenza A virus strains containing mutations that stabilize the Venus gene in Venus ⁇ PR8 (i.e., the number of strains containing the indicated amino acid/total number of strains available in the Influenza Research Database).
  • isolated refers to in vitro preparation and/or isolation of a nucleic acid molecule, e.g., vector or plasmid, peptide or polypeptide (protein), or virus of the disclosure, so that it is not associated with in vivo substances, or is substantially purified from in vitro substances.
  • An isolated virus preparation is generally obtained by in vitro culture and propagation, and/or via passage in eggs, and is substantially free from other infectious agents.
  • substantially purified means the object species is the predominant species, e.g., on a molar basis it is more abundant than any other individual species in a composition, e.g., is at least about 80% of the species present, and optionally 90% or greater, e.g., 95%, 98%, 99% or more, of the species present in the composition.
  • substantially free means below the level of detection for a particular infectious agent using standard detection methods for that agent.
  • a “recombinant” virus is one which has been manipulated in vitro, e.g., using recombinant DNA techniques, to introduce changes to the viral genome.
  • Reassortant viruses can be prepared by recombinant or nonrecombinant techniques.
  • the term “recombinant nucleic acid” or “recombinant DNA sequence or segment” refers to a nucleic acid, e.g., to DNA, that has been derived or isolated from a source, that may be subsequently chemically altered in vitro, so that its sequence is not naturally occurring, or corresponds to naturally occurring sequences that are not positioned as they would be positioned in the native genome.
  • An example of DNA “derived” from a source would be a DNA sequence that is identified as a useful fragment, and which is then chemically synthesized in essentially pure form.
  • DNA “isolated” from a source would be a useful DNA sequence that is excised or removed from said source by chemical means, e.g., by the use of restriction endonucleases, so that it can be further manipulated, e.g., amplified, for use in the invention, by the methodology of genetic engineering.
  • a “heterologous” influenza virus gene or viral segment is from an influenza virus source that is different than a majority of the other influenza viral genes or viral segments in a recombinant, e.g., reassortant, influenza virus.
  • isolated polypeptide examples include a polypeptide, peptide or protein encoded by cDNA or recombinant RNA including one of synthetic origin, or some combination thereof.
  • recombinant protein or “recombinant polypeptide” as used herein refers to a protein molecule expressed from a recombinant DNA molecule.
  • native protein is used herein to indicate a protein isolated from a naturally occurring (i.e., a nonrecombinant) source. Molecular biological techniques may be used to produce a recombinant form of a protein with identical properties as compared to the native form of the protein.
  • HSPs high scoring sequence pairs
  • T some positive-valued threshold score
  • Cumulative scores are calculated using, for nucleotide sequences, the parameters M (reward score for a pair of matching residues; always >0) and N (penalty score for mismatching residues; always ⁇ 0).
  • M forward score for a pair of matching residues; always >0
  • N penalty score for mismatching residues; always ⁇ 0.
  • a scoring matrix is used to calculate the cumulative score. Extension of the word hits in each direction are halted when the cumulative alignment score falls off by the quantity X from its maximum achieved value, the cumulative score goes to zero or below due to the accumulation of one or more negative-scoring residue alignments, or the end of either sequence is reached.
  • the BLAST algorithm may also perform a statistical analysis of the similarity between two sequences.
  • One measure of similarity provided by the BLAST algorithm may be the smallest sum probability (P(N)), which provides an indication of the probability by which a match between two nucleotide or amino acid sequences would occur by chance.
  • P(N) the smallest sum probability
  • a test nucleic acid sequence is considered similar to a reference sequence if the smallest sum probability in a comparison of the test nucleic acid sequence to the reference nucleic acid sequence is less than about 0.1, less than about 0.01, or less than about 0.001.
  • W wordlength
  • E expectation
  • BLOSUM62 scoring matrix See http://www.ncbi.n1m.nih.gov. Alignment may also be performed manually by inspection.
  • sequence comparison typically one sequence acts as a reference sequence to which test sequences are compared.
  • test and reference sequences are input into a computer, subsequence coordinates are designated if necessary, and sequence algorithm program parameters are designated.
  • sequence comparison algorithm then calculates the percent sequence identity for the test sequence(s) relative to the reference sequence, based on the designated program parameters.
  • Constant amino acid substitutions refer to the interchangeability of residues having similar side chains.
  • a group of amino acids having aliphatic side chains is glycine, alanine, valine, leucine, and isoleucine
  • a group of amino acids having aliphatic-hydroxyl side chains is serine and threonine
  • a group of amino acids having amide-containing side chains is asparagine and glutamine
  • a group of amino acids having aromatic side chains is phenylalanine, tyrosine and tryptophan
  • a group of amino acids having basic side chains is lysine, arginine and histidine
  • a group of amino acids having sulfur-containing side chain is cysteine and methionine.
  • conservative amino acid substitution groups are: threonine-valine-leucine-isoleucine-alanine; phenylalanine-tyrosine; lysine-arginine; alanine-valine; glutamic-aspartic; and asparagine-glutamine.
  • the viral segment for incorporation of heterologous gene sequences into a recombinant influenza virus includes at each end non-coding sequences that provide for encapsidation (incorporation or packaging) into virions.
  • the viral segments also include adjacent coding sequences, from one or both ends, that contribute to encapsidation, e.g., enhance encapsidation relative to viral segments that lack the adjacent coding sequences but have with the heterologous gene sequence.
  • the vectors with the viral segment having the heterologous gene sequence thus include encapsidation sequences that at the 3′ end of vRNA that may include adjacent 5′ coding sequences, at the 5′ end of vRNA that may include 3′ coding sequences, or at the 3′ end of vRNA that may include adjacent 5′ coding sequences and at the 5′ end of vRNA that may include 3′ coding sequences.
  • HA encapsidation sequences include sequences at the 3′ end of HA vRNA including 33-nt of non-coding sequences and at least 3, 6, 9, or 15 or up to about 216 nt of HA coding sequence and/or at the 5′ end of HA vRNA including about 45 nt of non-coding sequence and up to about 75, 80, 268 or 291 of HA coding sequence (Watanabe et al. 2003).
  • HS encapsidation sequences include sequences at the 3′ end of NS vRNA including at least 30, 60, 90 or 150 nt of coding sequence and at the 5′ end of NS vRNA including at least 30, 60, 90 or 100 nt of coding sequence (Fujii et al. 2005).
  • the 3′ NA incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 183, nucleotides 1 to 90, nucleotides 1 to 45, nucleotides 1 to 21, nucleotides 1 to 19 or any integer between 19 and 183, of the N-terminal NA coding region, and may include a mutation at the NA initiation codon.
  • the 5′ NA incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of NA, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 39, 78, or 157, or any integer between 1 and 157, nucleotides for C-terminal NA coding region.
  • the 5′ HA incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of HA, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 75, 80, 268, 291, or 518, or any integer between 1 and 518, nucleotides of the C-terminal HA coding region.
  • the 3′ HA incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 3, 1 to 6, 1 to 9, 1 to 15, 1 to 216, 1 to 468, or any integer between 1 and 468, of the N-terminal HA coding region.
  • the 3′ PB1 or PB2 incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 160 or 1 to 130 or any integer between 1 and 250, of the N-terminal PB1 or PB2 coding region.
  • the 5′ PB1 or PB2 incorporation sequences correspond to the 3′ most nucleotides, e.g., the 3′ 1 to 250 nucleotides, 1 to 200 nucleotides, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 160, 1 to 170 or 1 to 190, or any integer between 1 and 250, of the C-terminal PB1 or PB2 coding region.
  • the 3′ PA incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, or any integer between 1 and 250, of the N-terminal PA coding region.
  • the 5′ PA incorporation sequences correspond to the 3′ most nucleotides, e.g., the 3′ 1 to 250 nucleotides, 1 to 200 nucleotides, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 160, 1 to 170 or 1 to 190, or any integer between 1 and 250, of the C-terminal PA coding region.
  • the 3′ M incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 242, nucleotides 1 to 240 or any integer between 1 and 250, of the N-terminal M coding region, and may include a mutation at the M initiation codon.
  • the 5′ M incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of M, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 50, 100, or 220, or any integer between 1 and 250, nucleotides for C-terminal M coding region.
  • the 3′ NS or NP incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 30, or any integer between 1 and 250, e.g., 1 to 60, 1 to 70, 1 to 80 or 1 to 90 of the N-terminal NS or NP coding region, and may include a mutation at the NS or NP initiation codon.
  • the 5′ NS or NP incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of NS or NP, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 10, 30, 150, 200 or 250, or any integer between 1 and 250, nucleotides for the C-terminal NS or NP coding region, e.g., nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 30, or any integer between 1 and 250, e.g., 1 to 60, 1 to 70, 1 to 80 or 1 to 90 of the C-terminal NS or NP codon region.
  • influenza virus vectors which include sequences corresponding to the 3′ and 5′ noncoding regions of a particular vRNA, incorporation sequences of the corresponding vRNA, and a heterologous nucleic acid segment.
  • the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of NA vRNA, 3′ or 5′ NA vRNA incorporation sequences, and optionally both 3′ and 5′ NA incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of NA vRNA.
  • the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of HA vRNA, 5′ or 3′ HA vRNA incorporation sequences or both 5′ and 3′ HA incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of HA vRNA.
  • the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of NS vRNA, NS incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of NS vRNA.
  • the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of M vRNA, 5′ or 3′ M incorporation sequences or both 5′ and 3′ M incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of M vRNA.
  • the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of PB2 vRNA, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, PB2 incorporation sequences, and the 5′ noncoding region of PB2 vRNA.
  • PB2 incorporation sequences When two incorporation sequences are employed in a vector, they may be separated by the heterologous nucleic acid segment.
  • Each vector may be employed so as to prepare vRNA for introduction to a cell, or to express vRNA in a cell, in which other influenza virus vRNAs and proteins necessary for virus production, are present.
  • the heterologous gene sequence comprises sequences corresponding to an open reading frame for a therapeutic gene.
  • the heterologous gene sequence comprises sequences corresponding to an open reading frame for an immunogenic peptide or protein of a pathogen or a tumor cell, e.g., one useful to induce a protective immune response.
  • the heterologous nucleic acid segment may encode an immunogenic epitope useful in cancer therapy or a vaccine.
  • the vector comprising the heterologous nucleic acid segment may be prepared such that transcription of vector vRNA results in mRNA encoding a fusion protein with an influenza protein such as NA.
  • the heterologous nucleic acid segment may be fused with viral incorporation sequences so as to encode a fusion protein, e.g., a fusion with the N-terminal 21 residues of NA.
  • the fusion protein may comprise sequences from two different influenza virus proteins including sequences from two different NA or HA proteins.
  • the heterologous nucleic acid segment may comprise sequences corresponding to an IRES linked 5N to an open reading frame.
  • the heterologous gene sequence may encode a heterologous protein (a non-influenza viral protein such as a glycoprotein or a cytosolic, nuclear or mitochondrial specific protein), which may confer a detectable phenotype.
  • the heterologous gene sequence may be fused to truncated portions of PB2 coding sequences, e.g., those corresponding to 5′ or 3′ PB2 coding incorporation sequences, optionally forming a chimeric protein.
  • the heterologous nucleotide sequence replaces or is introduced to sequences in the viral viral segment corresponding to the coding region for that segment, so as not to disrupt the incorporation sequences in the coding region of the viral segment.
  • the heterologous nucleotide sequence may be flanked by about 3 to about 400 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ PB2 coding region adjacent to non-coding sequence.
  • the 3′ PB2 incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 3 to 400, nucleotides 3 to 300, nucleotides 3 to 100, nucleotides 3 to 50, or any integer between 3 and 400, of the N-terminal and/or C-terminal PB2 coding region.
  • a heterologous protein is produced which is a fusion with the N-terminus and/or C-terminus of the remaining residues of the deleted PB2 protein.
  • the vRNA for the additional viral segment or a viral segment having the heterologous gene sequence may be incorporated into virions at an efficiency that is at least 1%, 5%, 10%, or 30%, or at least 50%, that of a corresponding wild-type vRNA.
  • Influenza A viruses possess a genome of eight single-stranded negative-sense viral RNAs (vRNAs) that encode at least ten proteins.
  • the influenza virus life cycle begins with binding of the hemagglutinin (HA) to sialic acid-containing receptors on the surface of the host cell, followed by receptor-mediated endocytosis.
  • the low pH in late endosomes triggers a conformational shift in the HA, thereby exposing the N-terminus of the HA2 subunit (the so-called fusion peptide).
  • the fusion peptide initiates the fusion of the viral and endosomal membrane, and the matrix protein (M1) and RNP complexes are released into the cytoplasm.
  • RNPs consist of the nucleoprotein (NP), which encapsidates vRNA, and the viral polymerase complex, which is formed by the PA, PB1, and PB2 proteins. RNPs are transported into the nucleus, where transcription and replication take place.
  • the RNA polymerase complex catalyzes three different reactions: synthesis of an mRNA with a 5′ cap and 3′ polyA structure, of a full-length complementary RNA (cRNA), and of genomic vRNA using the cRNA as a template. Newly synthesized vRNAs, NP, and polymerase proteins are then assembled into RNPs, exported from the nucleus, and transported to the plasma membrane, where budding of progeny virus particles occurs.
  • NA neuraminidase
  • influenza B and C viruses are structurally and functionally similar to influenza A virus, there are some differences.
  • influenza B virus does not have a M2 protein with ion channel activity but has BM2 and has a viral segment with both NA and NB sequences.
  • Influenza C virus has only seven viral segments.
  • Any cell e.g., any avian or mammalian cell, such as a human, e.g., 293T or PER.C69 cells, or canine, e.g., MDCK, bovine, equine, feline, swine, ovine, rodent, for instance mink, e.g., MvLu1 cells, or hamster, e.g., CHO cells, or non-human primate, e.g., Vero cells, including mutant cells, which supports efficient replication of influenza virus can be employed to isolate and/or propagate influenza viruses. Isolated viruses can be used to prepare a reassortant virus.
  • canine e.g., MDCK, bovine, equine, feline, swine, ovine, rodent, for instance mink, e.g., MvLu1 cells, or hamster, e.g., CHO cells, or non-human primate, e.g., Vero
  • host cells for vaccine production are continuous mammalian or avian cell lines or cell strains.
  • a complete characterization of the cells to be used, may be conducted so that appropriate tests for purity of the final product can be included.
  • Data that can be used for the characterization of a cell includes (a) information on its origin, derivation, and passage history; (b) information on its growth and morphological characteristics; (c) results of tests of adventitious agents; (d) distinguishing features, such as biochemical, immunological, and cytogenetic patterns which allow the cells to be clearly recognized among other cell lines; and (e) results of tests for tumorigenicity.
  • the passage level, or population doubling, of the host cell used is as low as possible.
  • the cells are WHO certified, or certifiable, continuous cell lines.
  • the requirements for certifying such cell lines include characterization with respect to at least one of genealogy, growth characteristics, immunological markers, virus susceptibility tumorigenicity and storage conditions, as well as by testing in animals, eggs, and cell culture. Such characterization is used to confirm that the cells are free from detectable adventitious agents. In some countries, karyology may also be required. In addition, tumorigenicity may be tested in cells that are at the same passage level as those used for vaccine production. The virus may be purified by a process that has been shown to give consistent results, before vaccine production (see, e.g., World Health Organization, 1982).
  • Virus produced by the host cell may be highly purified prior to vaccine or gene therapy formulation.
  • the purification procedures result in extensive removal of cellular DNA and other cellular components, and adventitious agents. Procedures that extensively degrade or denature DNA may also be used.
  • a vaccine of the disclosure includes an isolated recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure, and optionally one or more other isolated viruses including other isolated influenza viruses, one or more immunogenic proteins or glycoproteins of one or more isolated influenza viruses or one or more other pathogens, e.g., an immunogenic protein from one or more bacteria, non-influenza viruses, yeast or fungi, or isolated nucleic acid encoding one or more viral proteins (e.g., DNA vaccines) including one or more immunogenic proteins of the isolated influenza virus of the disclosure.
  • the influenza viruses of the disclosure may be vaccine vectors for influenza virus or other pathogens.
  • a complete virion vaccine may be concentrated by ultrafiltration and then purified by zonal centrifugation or by chromatography.
  • Viruses other than the virus of the invention, such as those included in a multivalent vaccine may be inactivated before or after purification using formalin or beta-propiolactone, for instance.
  • a subunit vaccine comprises purified glycoproteins.
  • a vaccine may be prepared as follows: using viral suspensions fragmented by treatment with detergent, the surface antigens are purified, by ultracentrifugation for example.
  • the subunit vaccines thus contain mainly HA protein, and also NA.
  • the detergent used may be cationic detergent for example, such as hexadecyl trimethyl ammonium bromide (Bachmeyer, 1975), an anionic detergent such as ammonium deoxycholate (Laver & Webster, 1976); or a nonionic detergent such as that commercialized under the name TRITON X100.
  • the hemagglutinin may also be isolated after treatment of the virions with a protease such as bromelin, and then purified.
  • the subunit vaccine may be combined with an attenuated virus of the disclosure in a multivalent vaccine.
  • a split vaccine comprises virions which have been subjected to treatment with agents that dissolve lipids.
  • a split vaccine can be prepared as follows: an aqueous suspension of the purified virus obtained as above, inactivated or not, is treated, under stirring, by lipid solvents such as ethyl ether or chloroform, associated with detergents. The dissolution of the viral envelope lipids results in fragmentation of the viral particles. The aqueous phase is recuperated containing the split vaccine, constituted mainly of hemagglutinin and neuraminidase with their original lipid environment removed, and the core or its degradation products. Then the residual infectious particles are inactivated if this has not already been done.
  • the split vaccine may be combined with an attenuated virus of the disclosure in a multivalent vaccine.
  • Inactivated influenza virus vaccines are provided by inactivating replicated virus using known methods, such as, but not limited to, formalin or ⁇ -propiolactone treatment.
  • Inactivated vaccine types that can be used in the invention can include whole-virus (WV) vaccines or subvirion (SV) (split) vaccines.
  • WV vaccine contains intact, inactivated virus, while the SV vaccine contains purified virus disrupted with detergents that solubilize the lipid-containing viral envelope, followed by chemical inactivation of residual virus.
  • vaccines that can be used include those containing the isolated HA and NA surface proteins, which are referred to as surface antigen or subunit vaccines.
  • Live Attenuated Virus Vaccines can be used for preventing or treating influenza virus infection. Attenuation may be achieved in a single step by transfer of attenuated genes from an attenuated donor virus to a replicated isolate or reassorted virus according to known methods. Since resistance to influenza A virus is mediated primarily by the development of an immune response to the HA and/or NA glycoproteins, the genes coding for these surface antigens come from the reassorted viruses or clinical isolates. The attenuated genes are derived from an attenuated parent. In this approach, genes that confer attenuation generally do not code for the HA and NA glycoproteins.
  • Viruses are available that are capable of reproducibly attenuating influenza viruses, e.g., a cold adapted (ca) donor virus can be used for attenuated vaccine production. See, for example, Isakova-Sivall et al., 2014. Live, attenuated reassortant virus vaccines can be generated by mating the ca donor virus with a virulent replicated virus. Reassortant progeny are then selected at 25° C. (restrictive for replication of virulent virus), in the presence of an appropriate antiserum, which inhibits replication of the viruses bearing the surface antigens of the attenuated ca donor virus.
  • a cold adapted (ca) donor virus can be used for attenuated vaccine production. See, for example, Isakova-Sivall et al., 2014. Live, attenuated reassortant virus vaccines can be generated by mating the ca donor virus with a virulent replicated virus. Reassortant progeny are then selected at 25
  • Useful reassortants are: (a) infectious, (b) attenuated for seronegative non-adult mammals and immunologically primed adult mammals, (c) immunogenic and (d) genetically stable.
  • the immunogenicity of the ca reassortants parallels their level of replication.
  • Attenuating mutations can be introduced into influenza virus genes by site-directed mutagenesis to rescue infectious viruses bearing these mutant genes. Attenuating mutations can be introduced into non-coding regions of the genome, as well as into coding regions. Such attenuating mutations can also be introduced into genes other than the HA or NA, e.g., the PB2 polymerase gene. Thus, new donor viruses can also be generated bearing attenuating mutations introduced by site-directed mutagenesis, and such new donor viruses can be used in the production of live attenuated reassortants vaccine candidates in a manner analogous to that described above for the ca donor virus. Similarly, other known and suitable attenuated donor strains can be reassorted with influenza virus to obtain attenuated vaccines suitable for use in the vaccination of mammals.
  • such attenuated viruses maintain the genes from the virus that encode antigenic determinants substantially similar to those of the original clinical isolates. This is because the purpose of the attenuated vaccine is to provide substantially the same antigenicity as the original clinical isolate of the virus, while at the same time lacking pathogenicity to the degree that the vaccine causes minimal chance of inducing a serious disease condition in the vaccinated mammal.
  • viruses in a multivalent vaccine can thus be attenuated or inactivated, formulated and administered, according to known methods, as a vaccine to induce an immune response in an animal, e.g., a mammal. Methods are well-known in the art for determining whether such attenuated or inactivated vaccines have maintained similar antigenicity to that of the clinical isolate or high growth strain derived therefrom.
  • Such known methods include the use of antisera or antibodies to eliminate viruses expressing antigenic determinants of the donor virus; chemical selection (e.g., amantadine or rimantidine); HA and NA activity and inhibition; and nucleic acid screening (such as probe hybridization or PCR) to confirm that donor genes encoding the antigenic determinants (e.g., HA or NA genes) are not present in the attenuated viruses.
  • a reporter influenza virus e.g., allowing visualization of virus-infected cells to understand influenza virus-induced pathology
  • PR8, H1N1 influenza A/Puerto Rico/8/34
  • the inserted Venus gene was deleted during serial passages of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8, and WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 was significantly attenuated, the PB2 ⁇ E712D mutation was found to stabilize the Venus gene.
  • the mechanisms by which Venus gene deletion occurs and how the polymerase mutation stabilizes the Venus gene were investigated.
  • the disclosure provides an isolated recombinant influenza virus having PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and HA viral segments, wherein at least one of the viral segments is a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced genetic stability or enhanced replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue at position 180 in PA that is glutamine, a residue at position 200 in PA that is threonine, a
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, D, E, Q, or H
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, N, S, H, T, Y, or C
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, E, N, or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, C, S. M, F, P, G, or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D, Q, S, H, T, Y.
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K, S, T, Y, C, or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, H, D, S. H, T, Y, or C
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, K, H, R, Q, or N
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, N, S.
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G, S, M, or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, S, M, or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • the PA further comprises a residue at position 443 that is not arginine
  • the PB1 further comprises a residue at position 737 that is not lysine
  • the PB2 further comprises a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid
  • the NS viral segment encodes a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline
  • the HA viral segment encodes a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine, or any combination thereof.
  • the residue at position 443 of PA is K or H
  • the residue at position 737 of PB1 is H or R
  • the residue at position 25 of PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D
  • the residue at position 167 of NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T, or any combination thereof.
  • at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • the heterologous sequence is in the NS viral segment, M viral segment, NP viral segment, PA viral segment, PB1 viral segment, or the PB2 viral segment.
  • the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the recombinant virus comprises a further viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • the further viral segment is a NS viral segment, a M viral segment, a NP viral segment, a PA viral segment, a PB1 viral segment or a PB2 viral segment.
  • the virus has a HA that is H1, H2, H3, H5, H7, H9, or H10.
  • the virus is an influenza B virus.
  • an isolated recombinant influenza virus having PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and HA viral segments, wherein at least one of the viral segments is a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, and wherein at least one of the other viral segments is a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced genetic stability or replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue in PB
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, D, E, Q, or H
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, N, S, H, T, Y, or C
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, E, N, or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, G, or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D, Q, S, H, T, Y, C, K, R, or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K, S, T, Y, C, or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, H, D, S, H, T, Y, or C
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, K, H, R, Q, or N
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, N, S, H, T, Y, or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G, S, M, or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, S, M, or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D, Q, H, L, R or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • the PA further comprises a residue at position 443 that is not arginine
  • the PB1 further comprises a residue at position 737 that is not lysine
  • the PB2 further comprises a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid
  • the NS viral segment encodes a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline
  • the HA viral segment encodes a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine, or any combination thereof.
  • the residue at position 443 of PA is K or H
  • the residue at position 737 of PB1 is H or R
  • the residue at position 25 of PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D
  • the residue at position 167 of NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T, or any combination thereof.
  • at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • the heterologous sequence is in the NS viral segment, M viral segment, NP viral segment, PA viral segment, PB1 viral segment, or the PB2 viral segment.
  • the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the recombinant virus comprises a further viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • the further viral segment is a NS viral segment, a M viral segment, a NP viral segment, a PA viral segment, a PB1 viral segment or a PB2 viral segment.
  • the virus has a HA that is H1, H2, H3, H5, H7, H9, or H10.
  • the virus is an influenza B virus.
  • an isolated recombinant influenza virus having PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and HA viral segments, wherein the recombinant virus has two or more viral segments comprising a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced genetic stability or replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue in PB2 at position 712
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, D, E, Q, or H
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, N, S, H, T, Y, or C
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, E, N, or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, G, or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D, Q, S, H, T, Y, C, K, R, or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K, S, T, Y, C, or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, H, D, S, H, T, Y, or C
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, K, H, R, Q, or N
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, N, S, H, T, Y, or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G, S, M, or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, S, M, or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D, Q, H, L, R or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K or Q.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • the PA further comprises a residue at position 443 that is not arginine
  • the PB1 further comprises a residue at position 737 that is not lysine
  • the PB2 further comprises a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid
  • the NS viral segment encodes a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline
  • the HA viral segment encodes a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine, or any combination thereof.
  • the residue at position 443 of PA is K or H
  • the residue at position 737 of PB1 is H or R
  • the residue at position 25 of PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D
  • the residue at position 167 of NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T, or any combination thereof.
  • at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • the heterologous sequence is in the NS viral segment, M viral segment, NP viral segment, PA viral segment, PB1 viral segment, or the PB2 viral segment.
  • the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the recombinant virus comprises a further viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • the further viral segment is a NS viral segment, a M viral segment, a NP viral segment, a PA viral segment, a PB1 viral segment or a PB2 viral segment.
  • the virus has a HA that is H1, H2, H3, H5, H7, H9, or H10.
  • the virus is an influenza B virus.
  • the disclosure also provides a vaccine having the isolated recombinant virus.
  • the disclosure provides a plurality of influenza virus vectors for preparing a reassortant, comprising a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB1 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB2 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus HA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NP DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus M DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, and a vector for
  • the PB1, PB2, PA, NP, NS, and M DNAs in the vectors for vRNA production have a sequence corresponding to one that encodes a polypeptide having at least 95% amino acid sequence identity to a corresponding polypeptide encoded by SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • the vectors comprise a further vector having a viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • a method to prepare influenza virus comprising: contacting a cell with a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB1 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB2 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus HA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NP DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus M DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, and a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter oper
  • the cell is an avian cell or a mammalian cell. In one embodiment, the cell is a Vero cell, a human cell or a MDCK cell. In one embodiment, the wherein the PB1, PB2, PA, NP, NS, and M DNAs in the vectors for vRNA productions have a sequence that corresponds to one that encodes a polypeptide having at least 95% amino acid sequence identity to a corresponding polypeptide encoded by SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15.
  • the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H
  • the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N
  • the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H
  • the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V
  • the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G
  • the residue at position 684 is D or N
  • the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • the heterologous sequence e.g., for a therapeutic or prophylactic gene of interest, which may be in an additional influenza segment, e.g., in one of the segments of a 9 segment influenza A or B virus, in one of 8 viral segments, or in one of the segments in a 7 segment virus, may be an immunogen for a cancer associated antigen or for a pathogen such as a bacteria, a noninfluenza virus, fungus.
  • influenza viruses of the disclosure may be vaccine vectors for influenza virus and for at least one other pathogen, such as a viral or bacterial pathogen, or for a pathogen other than influenza virus, pathogens including but not limited to, lentiviruses such as HIV, hepatitis B virus, hepatitis C virus, herpes viruses such as CMV or HSV, Foot and Mouth Disease Virus, Measles virus, Rubella virus, Mumps virus, human Rhinovirus, Parainfluenza viruses, such as respiratory syncytial virus and human parainfluenza virus type 1, Coronavirus, Nipah virus, Hantavirus, Japanese encephalitis virus, Rotavirus, Dengue virus, West Nile virus, Streptococcus pneumoniae, Mycobacterium tuberculosis, Bordetella pertussis , or Haemophilus influenza.
  • pathogens including but not limited to, lentiviruses such as HIV, hepatitis B virus, hepatitis C virus,
  • the biologically contained influenza virus of the disclosure may include sequences for H protein of Measles virus, viral envelope protein E1 of Rubella virus, HN protein of Mumps virus, RV capsid protein VP1 of human Rhinovirus, G protein of Respiratory syncytial virus, S protein of Coronavirus, G or F protein of Nipah virus, G protein of Hantavirus, E protein of Japanese encephalitis virus, VP6 of Rotavirus, E protein of Dengue virus, E protein of West Nile virus, PspA of Streptococcus pneumonia , HSP65 from Mycobacterium tuberculosis , IRP1-3 of Bordetella pertussis , or the heme utilization protein, protective surface antigen D15, heme binding protein A, or outer membrane protein P1, P2, P5 or P6 of Haemophilus influenza.
  • the gene therapy vector may include a heterologous sequence useful to inhibit or treat, e.g., cancer, AIDS, adenosine deaminase, muscular dystrophy, ornithine transcarbamylase deficiency and central nervous system tumors, or pathogens, or may encode an antibody or fragment thereof, e.g., scFv or a single chain antibody.
  • compositions of the present disclosure suitable for inoculation, e.g., nasal, parenteral or oral administration, comprise one or more influenza virus isolates, e.g., one or more attenuated or inactivated influenza viruses, a subunit thereof, isolated protein(s) thereof, and/or isolated nucleic acid encoding one or more proteins thereof, optionally further comprising sterile aqueous or non-aqueous solutions, suspensions, and emulsions.
  • the compositions can further comprise auxiliary agents or excipients, as known in the art.
  • the composition of the disclosure is generally presented in the form of individual doses (unit doses).
  • Conventional vaccines generally contain about 0.1 to 200 ⁇ g, e.g., 30 to 100 ⁇ g, 0.1 to 2 ⁇ g, 0.5 to 5 ⁇ g, 1 to 10 ⁇ g, 10 ⁇ g to 20 ⁇ g, 15 ⁇ g to 30 ⁇ g, or 10 to 30 ⁇ g, of HA from each of the strains entering into their composition.
  • the vaccine forming the main constituent of the vaccine composition of the disclosure may comprise a single influenza virus, or a combination of influenza viruses, for example, at least two or three influenza viruses, including one or more reassortant(s).
  • Preparations for parenteral administration include sterile aqueous or non-aqueous solutions, suspensions, and/or emulsions, which may contain auxiliary agents or excipients known in the art.
  • non-aqueous solvents are propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, vegetable oils such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters such as ethyl oleate.
  • Carriers or occlusive dressings can be used to increase skin permeability and enhance antigen absorption.
  • Liquid dosage forms for oral administration may generally comprise a liposome solution containing the liquid dosage form.
  • Suitable forms for suspending liposomes include emulsions, suspensions, solutions, syrups, and elixirs containing inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as purified water. Besides the inert diluents, such compositions can also include adjuvants, wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, or sweetening, flavoring, or perfuming agents.
  • compositions of the present disclosure when used for administration to an individual, it can further comprise salts, buffers, adjuvants, or other substances which are desirable for improving the efficacy of the composition.
  • adjuvants substances which can augment a specific immune response, can be used. Normally, the adjuvant and the composition are mixed prior to presentation to the immune system, or presented separately, but into the same site of the organism being immunized.
  • Heterogeneity in a vaccine may be provided by mixing replicated influenza viruses for at least two influenza virus strains, such as 2-20 strains or any range or value therein.
  • Vaccines can be provided for variations in a single strain of an influenza virus, using techniques known in the art.
  • a pharmaceutical composition according to the present disclosure may further or additionally comprise at least one chemotherapeutic compound, for example, for gene therapy, immunosuppressants, anti-inflammatory agents or immune enhancers, and for vaccines, chemotherapeutics including, but not limited to, gamma globulin, amantadine, guanidine, hydroxybenzimidazole, interferon- ⁇ , interferon- ⁇ , interferon- ⁇ , tumor necrosis factor-alpha, thiosemicarbarzones, methisazone, rifampin, ribavirin, a pyrimidine analog, a purine analog, foscarnet, phosphonoacetic acid, acyclovir, dideoxynucleosides, a protease inhibitor, or ganciclovir.
  • chemotherapeutics including, but not limited to, gamma globulin, amantadine, guanidine, hydroxybenzimidazole, interferon- ⁇ ,
  • the composition can also contain variable but small quantities of endotoxin-free formaldehyde, and preservatives, which have been found safe and not contributing to undesirable effects in the organism to which the composition is administered.
  • the administration of the composition may be for either a “prophylactic” or “therapeutic” purpose.
  • the compositions of the disclosure which are vaccines are provided before any symptom or clinical sign of a pathogen infection becomes manifest.
  • the prophylactic administration of the composition serves to prevent or attenuate any subsequent infection.
  • the gene therapy compositions of the disclosure are provided before any symptom or clinical sign of a disease becomes manifest.
  • the prophylactic administration of the composition serves to prevent or attenuate one or more symptoms or clinical signs associated with the disease.
  • a viral vaccine is provided upon the detection of a symptom or clinical sign of actual infection.
  • the therapeutic administration of the compound(s) serves to attenuate any actual infection.
  • a gene therapy composition is provided upon the detection of a symptom or clinical sign of the disease.
  • the therapeutic administration of the compound(s) serves to attenuate a symptom or clinical sign of that disease.
  • a vaccine composition of the present disclosure may be provided either before the onset of infection (so as to prevent or attenuate an anticipated infection) or after the initiation of an actual infection.
  • the composition may be provided before any symptom or clinical sign of a disorder or disease is manifested or after one or more symptoms are detected.
  • a composition is said to be “pharmacologically acceptable” if its administration can be tolerated by a recipient mammal. Such an agent is said to be administered in a “therapeutically effective amount” if the amount administered is physiologically significant.
  • a composition of the present disclosure is physiologically significant if its presence results in a detectable change in the physiology of a recipient patient, e.g., enhances at least one primary or secondary humoral or cellular immune response against at least one strain of an infectious influenza virus.
  • the “protection” provided need not be absolute, i.e., the influenza infection need not be totally prevented or eradicated, if there is a statistically significant improvement compared with a control population or set of mammals. Protection may be limited to mitigating the severity or rapidity of onset of symptoms or clinical signs of the influenza virus infection.
  • a composition of the present disclosure may confer resistance to one or more pathogens, e.g., one or more influenza virus strains, by either passive immunization or active immunization.
  • active immunization an attenuated live vaccine composition is administered prophylactically to a host (e.g., a mammal), and the host's immune response to the administration protects against infection and/or disease.
  • a host e.g., a mammal
  • the elicited antisera can be recovered and administered to a recipient suspected of having an infection caused by at least one influenza virus strain.
  • a gene therapy composition of the present disclosure may yield prophylactic or therapeutic levels of the desired gene product by active immunization.
  • the vaccine is provided to a mammalian female (at or prior to pregnancy or parturition), under conditions of time and amount sufficient to cause the production of an immune response which serves to protect both the female and the fetus or newborn (via passive incorporation of the antibodies across the placenta or in the mother's milk).
  • the present disclosure thus includes methods for preventing or attenuating a disorder or disease, e.g., an infection by at least one strain of pathogen.
  • a vaccine is said to prevent or attenuate a disease if its administration results either in the total or partial attenuation (i.e., suppression) of a clinical sign or condition of the disease, or in the total or partial immunity of the individual to the disease.
  • a gene therapy composition is said to prevent or attenuate a disease if its administration results either in the total or partial attenuation (i.e., suppression) of a clinical sign or condition of the disease, or in the total or partial immunity of the individual to the disease.
  • a composition having at least one influenza virus of the present disclosure including one which is attenuated and one or more other isolated viruses, one or more isolated viral proteins thereof, one or more isolated nucleic acid molecules encoding one or more viral proteins thereof, or a combination thereof, may be administered by any means that achieve the intended purposes.
  • administration of such a composition may be by various parenteral routes such as subcutaneous, intravenous, intradermal, intramuscular, intraperitoneal, intranasal, oral or transdermal routes.
  • Parenteral administration can be accomplished by bolus injection or by gradual perfusion over time.
  • a typical regimen for preventing, suppressing, or treating an influenza virus related pathology comprises administration of an effective amount of a vaccine composition as described herein, administered as a single treatment, or repeated as enhancing or booster dosages, over a period up to and including between one week and about 24 months, or any range or value therein.
  • an “effective amount” of a composition is one that is sufficient to achieve a desired effect. It is understood that the effective dosage may be dependent upon the species, age, sex, health, and weight of the recipient, kind of concurrent treatment, if any, frequency of treatment, and the nature of the effect wanted.
  • the ranges of effective doses provided below are not intended to limit the invention and represent dose ranges.
  • the dosage of a live, attenuated or killed virus vaccine for an animal such as a mammalian adult organism may be from about 10 2 -10 20 , e.g., 10 3 -10 12 , 10 2 -10 10 , 10 5 -10 11 , 10 6 -10 15 , 10 2 -10 10 , or 10 15 -10 20 plaque forming units (PFU)/kg, or any range or value therein.
  • the dose of one viral isolate vaccine, e.g., in an inactivated vaccine may range from about 0.1 to 1000, e.g., 0.1 to 10 ⁇ g, 1 to 20 ⁇ g, 30 to 100 ⁇ g, 10 to 50 ⁇ g, 50 to 200 ⁇ g, or 150 to 300 ⁇ g, of HA protein.
  • the dosage should be a safe and effective amount as determined by conventional methods, using existing vaccines as a starting point.
  • the dosage of immunoreactive HA in each dose of replicated virus vaccine may be standardized to contain a suitable amount, e.g., 0.1 ⁇ g to 1 ⁇ g, 0.5 ⁇ g to 5 ⁇ g, 1 ⁇ g to 10 ⁇ g, 10 ⁇ g to 20 ⁇ g, 15 ⁇ g to 30 ⁇ g, or 30 ⁇ g to 100 ⁇ g or any range or value therein, or the amount recommended by government agencies or recognized professional organizations.
  • the quantity of NA can also be standardized, however, this glycoprotein may be labile during purification and storage.
  • the dosage of immunoreactive HA in each dose of replicated virus vaccine can be standardized to contain a suitable amount, e.g., 1-50 ⁇ g or any range or value therein, or the amount recommended by the U.S. Public Health Service (PHS), which is usually 15 ⁇ g, per component for older children >3 years of age, and 7.5 ⁇ g per component for children ⁇ 3 years of age.
  • PHS U.S. Public Health Service
  • the quantity of NA can also be standardized, however, this glycoprotein can be labile during the processor purification and storage (Kendal et al., 1980; Kerr et al., 1975).
  • Each 0.5-ml dose of vaccine may contain approximately 0.1 to 0.5 billion viral particles, 0.5 to 2 billion viral particles, 1 to 50 billion virus particles, 1 to 10 billion viral particles, 20 to 40 billion viral particles, 1 to 5 billion viral particles, or 40 to 80 billion viral particles.
  • the NS segments of PR8 fused with different fluorescent reporter genes including eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry were constructed by overlapping fusion PCR as described in Manicassamy et al. (2010).
  • the open reading frame (ORF) of the NS1 gene without the stop codon was fused with the N-terminus of fluorescent reporter genes via a sequence encoding the amino acid linker GSGG.
  • the fluorescent reporter ORFs were followed by a sequence encoding the GSG linker, a foot-and-mouth virus protease 2A autoproteolytic site with 57 nucleotides from porcine teschovirus-1 in Manicassamy et al.
  • WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 was generated by using the reverse genetics system as described in Newmann et al. (1999). Since WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 pathogenicity and Venus expression levels were appreciably attenuated in mice, WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 was serially passaged in mice. After six passages, a variant (MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8) was obtained with increased pathogenicity and strong Venus expression. A stock of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 was generated in MDCK cells.
  • MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 was recreated by using reverse genetics. Likewise, MA ⁇ eCFP-PR8, ⁇ eGFP-PR8, and ⁇ mCherry-PR8 were generated with the same genetic backbone as MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8.
  • mice Female, 6-week-old C57BLU6 (‘B6’) mice were purchased from Japan SLC, Inc. (Shizuoka, Japan). Mice were intranasally inoculated with Color-flu viruses, at the dosages indicated in the figure panels, in 50 ⁇ L of PBS under sevoflurane anesthesia, and body weights and survival were monitored for 14 days. Lungs were harvested from PBS-inoculated or Color-flu-infected mice for virus titration, flow cytometric analysis, and histological experiments at the times indicated in the figure panels. All animal experiments were performed in accordance with the regulations of the University of Tokyo Committee for Animal Care and Use and were approved by the Animal Experiment Committee of the Institute of Medical Science of the University of Tokyo.
  • Sections and cells were visualized by using a confocal microscope (Nikon A1, Nikon, Tokyo, Japan), controlled by NIS-Elements software.
  • a confocal microscope Nema, Nikon A1, Nikon, Tokyo, Japan
  • NIS-Elements software NIS-Elements software.
  • the slides were visualized by use of an inverted fluorescence microscope (Nikon Eclipse TS100) with a Nuance FX multispectral imaging system with InForm software (PerkinElmer, Waltham, Mass.).
  • mice were euthanized and intracardially perfused with PBS to remove blood cells from the lung.
  • the lungs were isolated after intratracheal perfusion with 4% PFA phosphate buffer solution.
  • the lung tissues were cleared with SCALEVIEW-A2 solution (Olympus, Tokyo, Japan) according to the manufacturer's instructions. Images were acquired by using a stereo fluorescence microscope (M205FA, Leica Microsystems, Wetzlar, Germany) equipped with a digital camera (DFC365FX, Leica Microsystems).
  • a total of 10 5 PFU of MA ⁇ eGFP ⁇ PR8 was intranasally inoculated into B6 mice.
  • 50 ⁇ L of PE ⁇ CD11b (M1/70, BioLegend, San Diego, Calif.) was injected intravenously to the mice at day 3 p.i.
  • the lungs of the mice were harvested.
  • the kinetics of eGFP- and PE-positive cells in the lungs were imaged with a multi-photon microscope (LSM 710 NLO, Carl Zeiss, Oberkochen, Germany).
  • the lungs were maintained in complete medium (RPMI 1640 with 10% fetal calf serum) in a humid chamber (37° C., 5% CO 2 ).
  • the data were processed with LSM software Zen 2009 (Carl Zeiss).
  • LSM software Zen 2009 Carl Zeiss
  • For three-dimensional imaging of HPAI virus-infected lung tissues B6 mice were intranasally inoculated with 10 5 PFU of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ HPAI virus.
  • the lung tissues were collected from the mice at day 2 p.i., and treated with SCALEVIEW-A2 solution (Olympus) to make tissues transparent as described above.
  • Three-dimensional images of lung tissues were obtained from a multi-photon microscope (Nikon A1R MP).
  • lungs were dissociated with Collagenase D (Roche Diagnostics, Mannheim, Germany; final concentration: 2 g/mL) and DNase I (Worthington Biochemical, Lakewood, N.J.; final concentration: 40 U/mL) for 30 minutes at 37° C. by grinding the tissue through nylon filters (BD Biosciences). Red blood cells (RBCs) were lysed by treatment with RBC lysing buffer (Sigma Aldrich, St. Louis, Mo.). To block nonspecific binding of antibodies, cells were incubated with purified anti-mouse CD16/32 (Fc Block, BD Biosciences, San Diego, Calif.). Cells were stained with appropriate combinations of fluorescent antibodies to analyze the population of each immune cell subset.
  • anti-CD45 (30-F11: eBioscience, San Diego, Calif.), anti-CD11b (M1/70: BioLegend), anti-F4180 (BM8: eBioscience), and anti-CD11c (HL3: BD Biosciences). All samples were also incubated with 7-aminoactinomycin D (Via-Probe, BD Biosciences) for dead cell exclusion. Data from labeled cells were acquired on a FACSAria II (BD Biosciences) and analyzed with FlowJo software version 9.3.1 (Tree Star, San Carlos, Calif.). To isolate Venus-positive and -negative macrophages from lungs, stained cells were sorted using a FACSAria II (BD Biosciences).
  • RNA of sorted macrophages was extracted using TRIzol reagent (Life Technologies, Carlsbad, Calif.) and precipitated with isopropanol. RNA amplification was performed using the Arcturus Riboamp Plus RNA Amplification Kit (Life technologies) in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. RNA was labeled by using the Agilent Low Input Quick Amp Labeling kit, one color (Agilent Technologies, Santa Clara, Calif.) and hybridized to the SurePrint G3 Mouse GE 8X60K microarray (Agilent Technologies).
  • Arrays were scanned with a DNA Microarray Scanner with SureScan High-Resolution Technology, (G2565CA; Agilent Technologies), and data were acquired using Agilent Feature Extraction software ver. 10.7.3.1. (Agilent Technologies). Probe annotations were provided by Agilent Technologies (AMADID 028005). Probe intensities were background corrected and normalized using the normal-exponential and quantile methods, respectively. The log 2 of the intensities were then fit to a linear model that compared the groups of interest 34 . All reported p values were adjusted for multiple hypothesis comparisons using the Benjamini-Hochberg method. Transcripts were considered differentially expressed if there was at least a 2-fold change in the mean probe intensity between contrasts with an adjusted p ⁇ 0.01.
  • Hierarchical clustering was performed in R. The resultant gene clusters were then analyzed with ToppCluster (Kaimal et al., 2010) to identify gene annotations that were enriched in each cluster. The reported scores are the ⁇ log 10 of the Benjamini-Hochberg adjusted p-value.
  • Venus was chosen, a GFP variant with eight mutations including F46L, which improves chromophore formation and increases brightness compared with GFP (Wagai et al., 2002).
  • B6 mice were intranasally infected with 10 4 PFU of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 or PR8 virus.
  • the lung virus titers were similar for MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8- and PR8-infected mice ( FIG. 1B ).
  • plaque assays were performed using lung homogenate from infected mice and found that only one of 150 plaques on each of days 3, 5, and 7 post-infection (p.i.) was Venus-negative, attesting to the high genetic stability of Venus expression in this recombinant virus.
  • p.i. the reporter protein
  • the robust virulence and genetic stability of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 indicate that this virus represents a highly attractive reporter system to visualize influenza virus-infected cells in vivo.
  • mice from each group were killed on days 3, 5 and 7 p.i., and virus titres in the lungs were determined in MDCK cells. **Statistical significance was calculated by using the Student's t-test; the P value was ⁇ 0.01 compared with the titres in the lungs of mice infected with WT-PR8 virus.
  • eCFP ex. 434 nm, em. 477 nm
  • eGFP ex. 489 nm, em. 508 nm
  • a mCherry variant (ex. 587 nm, em. 610 nm), which emits fluorescence at a longer wavelength than Venus (ex. 515 nm, em. 528 nm) (Nagai et al., 2002; Shaner et al., 2004), was also generated.
  • Color-flu These influenza viruses encoding the multi-spectral fluorescent reporter proteins were collectively named “Color-flu”.
  • the virus titres in mouse lung tissues and the MLD 50 values of MA ⁇ eCFP, eGFP and mCherry-PR8 were compared with those of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 and MA ⁇ PR8. All of virus strains showed comparatively high replication in the lungs and the MLD 50 values were similar among the Color-flu viruses (Table 1). The stability of the fluorescent expression of the Color-flu viruses was tested in vivo and in vitro by plaque assay.
  • the percentages of fluorescent-positive plaques were 98.0% (MA ⁇ eCFP-PR8), 100.0% (MA ⁇ eGFP ⁇ PR8) and 96.4% (MA ⁇ mCherry ⁇ PR8).
  • the percentages of fluorescent-positive plaques in the sample from the culture medium of MDCK cells after 72 hours p.i. was found to be 100.0% (MA ⁇ eCFP-PR8), 99.2% (MA ⁇ eGFP ⁇ PR8) and 98.2% (MA ⁇ mCherry ⁇ PR8).
  • NS1-fluorescent protein chimera in virus-infected cells was examined by infecting MDCK cells with MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 virus and detecting NS1 ⁇ Venus chimeric protein by using anti-GFP and anti-NS1 antibodies.
  • the NS1 ⁇ Venus chimeric protein was not degraded until the time point examined (that is, 12 hours p.i.), indicating that the fluorescent signal is mainly emitted from the NS1-fluorescent protein chimera and not from degradation products in cells infected with Color-flu viruses.
  • lungs were collected from B6 mice infected with each of the Color-flu viruses and processed them for visualization as described in the Methods section. All four colors were clearly visible in whole transparent lung tissue when analyzed with a fluorescent stereomicroscope ( FIG. 2A ). Fluorescent signals were mainly seen in the bronchial epithelial layer at day 3 p.i. At day 5 p.i., fluorescent signals extended to the peripheral alveolar regions. These data indicate that all four Color-flu viruses are useful for analyzing the distribution of influenza virus-infected cells in mouse lungs.
  • the NuanceTM spectral imaging system was employed to test whether the fluorescent signals of all four Color-flu viruses could be detected simultaneously.
  • Lung tissues were collected from B6 mice intranasally inoculated with a mixture of the four strains (2.5 ⁇ 10 4 PFU each in a total volume of 50 ⁇ L).
  • Analysis of lung sections obtained at days 2 and 5 p.i. showed that the fluorescent signals of all four Color-flu viruses were distinguishable from each other ( FIG. 2B ).
  • clusters of the same fluorescent color were found in bronchial epithelial cells, suggesting local spread of the individual viruses.
  • a limited number of alveolar cells were infected.
  • CD11b+ alveolar macrophages were detected by use of a two-photon laser microscope. Most of these macrophages did not migrate (i.e., showed little movement) during the observation period (49 minutes; data not shown). In mice infected with MA ⁇ eGFP ⁇ PR8 virus, many CD11b+ macrophages appeared to be ‘attached’ to eGFP-positive epithelial cells (data not shown); moreover, some of these eGFP-positive epithelial cells exhibited blebbing similar to apoptotic cells.
  • the present system can thus be used to monitor the in vivo interactions between virus-infected and immune cells.
  • Macrophages isolated from the lungs of mice inoculated with PBS served as controls.
  • fluorescent-positive macrophages 6,199 transcripts were differently expressed relative to naive macrophages.
  • fluorescent-negative macrophages obtained from infected mice only 4,252 transcripts were differentially expressed relative to the naive macrophages. This difference likely reflects differences in gene transcription induced by active influenza virus infection.
  • the fluorescent-negative cell populations obtained from infected animals may have included infected cells in which the fluorescent signal had not yet been detected as would be expected at an early stage of virus infection. In fact, confocal microscopy revealed that it took 9 hours to detect fluorescent protein expression in the majority of MDCK cells.
  • the upregulation of these pathways in the fluorescent-negative cells may have resulted from cell activation by IFN and cytokines released from infected cells, and/or from cells that were at an early stage of virus infection (as discussed earlier).
  • a subset of enriched annotations, for example, type I IFN-mediated signaling included transcripts that were more highly expressed in fluorescent-positive macrophages.
  • type I IFN genes were among the most upregulated transcripts in the fluorescent-positive macrophages ( FIG. 3E ).
  • this enhanced type I IFN activity is consistent with the suggestion that the fluorescent-positive cells had been infected whereas the fluorescent-negative cells included both uninfected (but potentially ‘stimulated’) cells and cells at early stages of influenza virus infection. Indeed, it took at least 5 hours to detect fluorescent protein expression after infection with Color-flu viruses, although all of the fluorescent proteins (that is, eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry) were detectable in the majority of cells by 9 hours p.i.
  • H5N1 highly pathogenic avian influenza A
  • HPAI highly pathogenic avian influenza A
  • An MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ HPAI virus based on A/Vietnam/1203/2004 (VN1203; H5N1) was generated, employing the same strategy used to create MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8; however, the PR8 NS gene was used to express NS1 ⁇ Venus chimeric protein because Venus virus with the VN1203 NS gene did not contribute to pathogenicity in mice.
  • the pathogenicity of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ HPAI virus for B6 mice was comparable to that of VN1203, with MLD 50 values for both viruses being less than 5 PFU ( FIG. 4A and Hatta et al., 2007).
  • MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ HPAI virus also shared with other HPAI viruses the ability to spread systemically and replicate in various organs including spleen, kidney, and brain ( FIG. 4B and Hatta et al., 2007).
  • a three-dimensional image of an HPAI virus-infected bronchus deep inside the lung tissues was successfully constructed ( FIG. 4C and data not shown).
  • Color-flu viruses were generated to study influenza virus infections at the cellular level. Color-flu viruses combine several improvements over existing systems, including robust viral replication, virulence, stable fluorescent protein expression, and a set of four different colors that can be visualized simultaneously. Color-flu viruses are applicable to all influenza virus strains. These improvements allowed global transcriptomics analyses of infected and bystander cells and, for the first time, live-imaging of influenza virus-infected cells in the mouse lung.
  • Newer technologies for imaging analysis have enabled the development of a set of four different influenza color variants that can be distinguished from one another by using NuanceTM, hence allowing their simultaneous detection.
  • our pilot study identified lung epithelial cells expressing two or three different fluorescent proteins ( FIG. 2C ). This may be the first visualization of mouse lung cells infected with more than one influenza virus strain.
  • influenza virus-infected cells were detected in whole lung tissues of mice, allowing the observation of the location and distribution of influenza viruses in the lung. Moreover, interactions of virus-infected epithelial cells with immune cells were observed. Such studies will allow direct monitoring influenza disease progression from acute bronchitis to severe viral pneumonia, which causes considerable morbidity and mortality in highly pathogenic influenza virus infections (Gambotto et al., 2008; Shieh et al., 2009).
  • Color-flu viruses in combination with advanced imaging technologies allow for detection at the cellular level in animals.
  • an H5N1 virus with the Venus (Nagai et al., 2002) (a variant of eGFP) reporter gene (designated wild-type Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus, and abbreviated as WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus) was prepared using reverse genetics; this virus showed moderate virulence and low Venus expression in mice.
  • DMEM Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium
  • MDCK Madin-Darby canine kidney
  • MEM minimal essential medium
  • Plasmids for virus rescue was constructed as described in Neumann et al. (1999). To measure viral polymerase activity, the open reading frames of the PB1, PB2, PA, and NP of influenza virus were amplified by PCR with gene-specific primers and cloned into the pCAGGS/MCS protein expression plasmid (Dias et al., 2009). The primer sequences are listed below:
  • Influenza A viruses were generated by using plasmid-based reverse genetics, as described previously (Murakami, 2008; Ozawa et al.; 2007). Viral titers of the rescued viruses were determined by use of plaque assays in MDCK cells. All rescued viruses were sequenced to confirm the absence of unwanted mutations.
  • mice Six-week-old female C57/BL6 (B6) mice (Japan SLC, Inc., Shizuoka, Japan) were used in this study. To measure viral replication in mice, six mice in each group were anesthetized with isoflurane and then intranasally inoculated with 105 PFU (50 ⁇ L) of virus. On days 1 and 3 post-infection (p.i.) three mice were euthanized, and their organs including the lungs, kidneys, spleens, and brains were collected and titrated in MDCK cells.
  • mice from each group were inoculated intranasally with 10-fold serial dilutions containing 10 0 to 10 5 PFU (50 L) of virus, respectively. Body weight and survival were monitored daily for 14 days.
  • the MLD 50 was calculated by using the method of Reed and Muench (1938). All mouse experiments were performed in accordance with the University of Tokyo's Regulations for Animal Care and Use and were approved by the Animal Experiment Committee of the Institute of Medical Science, the University of Tokyo.
  • Virus Passage in Mice and MDCK Cells Mouse adaptation of virus was performed as described in Example I.
  • confluent MDCK cells were infected with virus at a multiplicity of infection (MOI) of 0.0001.
  • MOI multiplicity of infection
  • hpi the supernatants were collected and titered in MDCK cells.
  • the new, harvested viruses were used to infect MDCK cells for the next passage. This procedure was repeated five times.
  • Each virus was inoculated into triplicate wells of subconfluent MDCK cells at an MOI of 0.0001.
  • the cells were supplemented with MEM containing 0.3% bovine serum albumin (BSA) and 1 ⁇ g/mL tosylsulfonyl phenylalanyl chloromethyl ketone (TPCK) trypsin and incubated at 37° C. in 5% CO 2 .
  • Culture supernatants were harvested at the indicated hours post-infection. The viral titers of the supernatants at the different time-points were determined by use of plaque assays in MDCK cells.
  • Mini-Genome Luciferase Assay Polymerase activity was tested with a mini-genome assay by using the dual-luciferase system as previously described in Murakami (2008) and Ozawa et al. (2007). Briefly, 293 cells were transfected with viral protein expression plasmids for NP, PB1, PB2, and PA from the WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 or MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus (0.2 ⁇ g each), with a plasmid expressing a reporter vRNA encoding the firefly luciferase gene under the control of the human RNA polymerase I promoter (pPoll/NP(0)Fluc(0), 0.2 ⁇ g), and with pRL-null (Promega, 0.2 ⁇ g), which encodes the Renilla luciferase, as an internal transfection control.
  • pPoll/NP(0)Fluc(0) 0.2 ⁇ g
  • pRL-null Promega, 0.2 ⁇
  • cell lysate was prepared with the Dual-Luciferase Reporter Assay System (Promega) and luciferase activity was measured by using the GloMax 96 microplate luminometer (Promega). The assay was standardized against Renilla luciferase activity. All experiments were performed in triplicate.
  • a linear mixed-effects model was fitted to the data using the R package NLME, and the time, the virus strain, and the interaction between these two factors were considered.
  • a contrast matrix was built to compare the strains in a pairwise fashion at the same time points (e.g., group_1 vs group_2 at 24 hours post-infection, group_1 vs group_3 at 24 hours post-infection, group_2 vs group_3 at 24 hours post-infection), using the R package PHIA.
  • the final p-values were adjusted by using Holm's method to account for multiple comparisons. In all cases, the results were considered statistically significant if we obtained In all cases, the results were considered statistically significant if we obtained p-values (or adjusted p-values) ⁇ 0.05.
  • the NS segment of A/Viet Nam/1203/2004 (abbreviated as VN1203) was substituted with a Venus-fused NS segment of Venus ⁇ PR8 virus by using reverse genetics, and acquired an H5N1 virus that expressed the Venus fluorescent reporter gene (WT ⁇ Venus-1H51N11 virus).
  • a pathogenicity analysis in mice revealed that this virus exhibited attenuated virulence in mice compared with that of the parental VN1203 with an MLD 50 value of 10 3 PFU (compared with 0.7 PFU for VN1203) ( FIGS. 6A and 6B and Hatta et al. (2007)).
  • WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus mainly replicated in respiratory organs (Table 3), and its Venus expression was very weak in both MDCK cells ( FIG. 7 ) and in mice after virus infection ( FIG. 8 ).
  • mice from each group were euthanized on days 1 and 3 p.i., and virus titers were determined in samples of lung, spleen, kidney, and brain in MDCK cells.
  • b no virus was isolated from the sample.
  • c P value was ⁇ 0.01 compared with the titers in the lungs of mice infected with WT-Venus-H5N1 virus.
  • d P value was ⁇ 0.05 compared with the titers in the lungs of mice infected with WT-Venus-H5N1 virus.
  • MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus was obtained.
  • MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus was lethal to mice with an MLD 50 of 3.2 PFU (Example 1). This virus replicated systemically in mice; on day 1 p.i., high viral titers were detected in lungs, spleens, and kidneys, and on day 3 p.i. virus could be detected in brains (Table 3).
  • Table 3 we detected high Venus expression of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus in MDCK cells ( FIG. 7 ) and in mice ( FIG. 8 ).
  • MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus showed much higher pathogenicity in mice and a higher replicative ability. Moreover, this virus exhibited high Venus expression during its replication in vitro and in vivo.
  • V25A of PB2 and R443K of PA Determine the Pathogenicity and Venus Expression of Venus ⁇ H5N1 Virus in Mice.
  • RG ⁇ MA virus exhibited similar viral titers in organs, MLD 50 value ( FIGS. 6C and 6D and FIG. 9 ), and Venus expression in mice ( FIG. 9 ) to those of its original virus (MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus).
  • the recombinant viruses that contained the PB1, NA, or NS gene of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus displayed similar pathogenicity in mice to that of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 (MLD 50 , 103 PFU) ( FIG. 9 ), whereas the reassortants with the PB2, PA, or M gene of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 (designated WT+MA ⁇ PB2, WT+MA ⁇ PA, or WT+MA ⁇ M) exhibited higher pathogenicity in mice than WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 ( FIG. 9 ).
  • WT+MA ⁇ PB2 and WT+MA ⁇ PA replicated more efficiently in mouse lungs than did WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1; moreover virus was detected in the spleens of two of three mice infected with WT+MA ⁇ PB2.
  • the effect of the PB2, PA, or M genes derived from WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 on the virulence of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 was also examined by generating three single-gene recombinant viruses, each containing the PB2, PA, or M gene from WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus and the remaining segments from MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus (designated MA+WT ⁇ PB2, MA+WT ⁇ PA, or MA+WT ⁇ M).
  • the MLD 50 values of MA+WT ⁇ PB2 and MA+WT ⁇ PA were 10 23 PFU, significantly higher than that of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 (MLD 50 , 3.2 PFU), whereas the virulence of MA+WT ⁇ M in mice was similar with that of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 ( FIG. 9 ). These data suggest that the PB2 and PA genes played a role in the pathogenicity of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus in mice.
  • a reassortant carrying both the PB2 and PA genes of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 [MA ⁇ (PB2+PA)] on the WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus backbone and a reciprocal reassortant on the MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus backbone [designated WT+MA ⁇ (PB2+PA) and MA+WT ⁇ (PB2+PA)] were rescued, and assessed for virulence in mice.
  • the replicative ability of these viruses was further examined in MDCK cells and it was found that the MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus had similar replicative capability with RG ⁇ MA virus and grew more efficiently than WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus, and that the titers of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus were significantly higher than those of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus at 36 and 48 hpi ( FIG. 10 ). The contribution of the PB2 and PA viral segments to the replication of the two viruses was then investigated.
  • the polymerase activity of the viral ribonucleoprotein (RNP) complex has been correlated with viral replication and virulence (Gabriel et al., 2005; Leung et al., 2010; Li et al., 2008; Salomen et al., 2006).
  • the activity of the eight RNP combinations of PB1, PB2, and PA from either WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 or MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus was determined by measuring luciferase activity.
  • the polymerase activity of the mouse-adapted virus was near 4-fold less than that of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus ( FIG. 11 ).
  • Venus-negative plaques were acquired from reassortants with the MA ⁇ PB1, MA ⁇ NA, or MA ⁇ M gene, but we did not obtain any Venus-negative plaques from the fifth passages of Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus with the MA ⁇ PB2, MA ⁇ PA, MA ⁇ (PB2+PA), or MA ⁇ NS gene (Table 5). These data suggest that the MA ⁇ PB2, ⁇ PA, and ⁇ NS genes may play roles in Venus stability.
  • Venus expression of different passage stocks was detected in MDCK cells by using fluorescence microscopy. Venus-negative plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells. Amplified Venus-negative plaques were rechecked for Venus expression to exclude false-negative plaques. b 69 plaques of the fifth passage stock of WT + MA-M were checked by using fluorescence microscopy, all of which were “Venus-negative”. Ten of these plaques were picked up to further confirm the lack of Venus expression, all of which were confirmed to be Venus-negative.
  • the NS segments of the fifth-passage stocks from different reassortants were amplified by using PCR and NS-specific primers. Except for the Venus-NS segment (1.9 kb), the deleted NS segments were detectable, at a level similar to that for the NS segment of PR8, at less than 1 kb.
  • the deleted NS segments of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 and of the reassortants with the MA ⁇ NA and MA ⁇ M genes were much brighter than those of the other reassortants ( FIG. 12 ), further implying that the MA ⁇ NA and MA ⁇ M genes do not contribute to Venus stability in vitro.
  • mice were inoculated with 105 PFU of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus, RG ⁇ MA virus, or WT+MA ⁇ (PB2+PA) virus. Lungs were collected on day 4 p.i., before the mice died, and were homogenized in PBS. The supernatants were inoculated into MDCK cells, and at 48 hpi Venus-negative plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells. It should be noted that sometimes the Venus signal of the plaque correlates with the condition of the cultured cells and the detection time. Therefore the Venus expression of amplified Venus-negative plaques was rechecked in MDCK cells to exclude false negatives.
  • V25A of P1B2 also significantly increased Venus expression and viral replication in MDCK cells and in mice, and that R443K of PA further enhanced these effects.
  • the stability of different reassortants was examined in vitro, the reassortants with MA ⁇ PB2, MA ⁇ PA, or MA ⁇ NS were found to be more stable. These results suggest that the PB32 and PA proteins play roles in the pathogenicity and Venus stability of Venus-expressing H5N1 viruses in mammalian hosts.
  • the pathogenicity of highly pathogenic H5N1 avian influenza viruses in mammals is determined by multiple viral genes.
  • the HA protein plays crucial roles in the systemic replication and lethal infection of H5 subtype viruses in chickens (Kawaoka and Webster, 1988) and mammals (Hatta et al., 2001; Suguitan et al., 2012).
  • the HA and NS genes of H5N1 virus also contribute to high virulence in ferrets (Imai et al., 2010).
  • the NS1 protein helps to subvert the antiviral immune response of the host and is essential for the pathogenicity of H5N1 viruses in mice (Jiao et al., 2005).
  • RNA polymerase of influenza A virus consists of the PB1, PB2, and PA subunits, and is implicated in numerous essential processes in the viral life cycle (Naffakh et al., 2005).
  • PB1 performs polymerase and endonuclease activities
  • PB2 is responsible for capped-RNA recognition
  • PA is involved in RNA replication and proteolytic activity (Obayasjo et al., 2005).
  • the interfaces of these polymerase subunits are essential for transcription initiation (He et al., 2008; Sugiyama et al., 2009).
  • Residues 1-37 at the N-terminus of the PB2 protein play a vital role in binding to the PB1 protein and affect the RNA polymerase activity, and these residues are highly conserved among all subtypes of influenza virus (Sugiyama et al., 2009).
  • the amino acid at position 25 of PB2 is located within the third ⁇ -helix (amino acids 25 to 32) of its PB1-binding domain (Sugiyama et al., 2009).
  • the amino acid at position 25 in PB2 was found to be changeable, and V25A in PB2 was found to increase viral replication in mammalian cells and in mice, resulting in higher pathogenicity of the H5N1 virus in mice.
  • the R443 residue of the PA protein also plays a role in replication activity (Obayashi et al., 2008; Regan et al., 2006), and the mutation R443A in PA prevents the production of infectious virus (Regan et al., 2006).
  • reassortants with R443K in their PA protein were rescued, and demonstrated that R443K in PA enhances viral replication in mouse lungs, reinforcing it was the virulence of H5N1 virus in mice.
  • the present data thus further emphasize the role of the amino acid at position 443 of the PA protein for influenza virus.
  • influenza virus-related research Heaton et al, 2013; Helft et al., 2012; Manicassamy et al., 2010; Pan et al., 2013; Example 1).
  • An effective virus for this purpose should have good replicative ability and show considerable pathogenicity in its host. Moreover, it should both highly and stably express its fluorescent reporter protein.
  • influenza A viruses carrying the GFP reporter gene have been reported (Kittel et al., 2004; Manicassamy et al., 2010); however, some of these viruses showed low replication or poor pathogenicity in mice (Kittle et al., 2004), while some produced relatively low fluorescent signals or did not stably express GFP during virus replication in vitro and in vivo (Manicassamy et al., 2010).
  • the present data demonstrate that not only is MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ H5N1 virus highly pathogenic to mice, but it also highly and stably expresses Venus fluorescent protein in vitro and in vivo.
  • Madin-Darby canine kidney (MDCK) cells were maintained in minimum essential medium (MEM) containing 5% of newborn calf serum (NCS).
  • MEM minimum essential medium
  • HEK293T Human embryonic kidney 293T
  • HEK293 cells were maintained in Dulbecco's modified Eagle medium supplemented with 10% fetal calf serum (FCS).
  • A/Puerto Rico/8/34 H1N1; PR8 (Horimoto et al., 2007) and each NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 virus were generated by using reverse genetics and were propagated in MDCK cells at 37° C.
  • TPCK L-(tosylamido-2-phenyl) ethyl chloromethyl ketone
  • BSA bovine serum albumin
  • NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 virus in mice Six- to eight-week-old female C57BL/6 mice (Japan SLC) were intranasally infected with 50 ⁇ L of 2.3 ⁇ 10 6 plaque-forming units (PFU) of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 virus. Lungs were harvested 3-6 days post-infection (dpi) and homogenized in 1 mL of phosphate-buffered saline (PBS). To obtain a clone with high proliferative ability and Venus expression, plaque purification of the lung homogenate using MDCK cells was performed. A large, highly Venus-expressing plaque was picked and the cloned virus was propagated in MDCK cells at 37° C. for 48 hours, then 50 ⁇ L of the supernatant was used as an inoculum for the next passage. These procedures were repeated six times.
  • PFU plaque-forming units
  • Sequence analysis Sequence analysis of viral RNA was performed as described previously (Sakabe et al., 2011). Briefly, viral RNAs were extracted by using a QIAamp Viral RNA mini kit (QIAGEN) and Superscript IIITM reverse transcriptase (Invitrogen) and an oligonucleotide complementary to the 12-nucleotide sequence at the 3′ end of the viral RNA (Katz et al., 1990) were used for reverse transcription of viral RNAs. Each segment was amplified by using PCR with Phusion High Fidelity DNA polymerase (Finnzymes) and primers specific for each segment of the PR8 virus. The PCR products were purified and their sequences determined by using ABI 3130xl (Applied Biosystems).
  • Plasmid construction and reverse genetics Plasmid construction and reverse genetics. Plasmids containing the cloned cDNAs of PR8 genes between the human RNA polymerase I promoter and the mouse RNA polymerase I terminator (referred to as Poll plasmid) were used for reverse genetics and as templates for mutagenesis. The mutations found in NS1-Venus PR8 virus after passage were introduced into the plasmid constructs of PR8 by using site-directed mutagenesis (referred to as pPoIIR-PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D and pPolIR-PR8 ⁇ HA ⁇ T380A, respectively). Reverse genetics was performed as described previously (Neumann et al., 1999).
  • the eight Poll plasmids were cotransfected into HEK293T cells together with eukaryotic protein expressing plasmids for PB2, PB1, PA, and NP derived from PR8 by using the TransIT-293 transfection reagent (Mirus). Forty-eight hours after transfection, the supernatant was harvested and propagated once in MDCK cells at 37° C. for 48 hours in MEM containing TPCK-treated trypsin (0.8 ⁇ g/mL) and 0.3% BSA. Cell debris was removed by centrifugation at 2,100 ⁇ g for 20 minutes at 4° C., and the supernatants were stored at ⁇ 80° C. until use. The virus titers were determined by means of a plaque assay using MDCK cells.
  • Polykaryon formation assay was performed as described previously (Imai et al., 2012) with modifications.
  • HEK293 cells propagated in 24-well plates were infected with wild-type PR8 or PR8 possessing the hemagglutinin (HA) mutation found in NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus in DMEM containing 10% FCS at a multiplicity of infection (MOI) of 10.
  • MOI multiplicity of infection
  • cells were washed with MEM containing 0.3% BSA and treated with TPCK-treated trypsin (1 ⁇ g/mL) in MEM containing 0.3% BSA for 15 minutes at 37° C. to cleave the HA on the cell surface into HA1 and HA2.
  • Trypsin was inactivated by washing the cells with DMEM containing 10% FCS.
  • low-pH buffer 145 mM NaCl, 20 mM sodium citrate (pH 6.0-5.4)
  • DMEM containing 10% FCS fetal calf serum
  • the cells were incubated for 2 hours at 37° C.
  • the cells were then fixed with methanol and stained with Giemsa's solution.
  • a microscope mounted with a digital camera (Nikon) was used to obtain photographic images.
  • MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1 without trypsin.
  • the cells were lysed with Novex® Tris-Glycine SDS sample buffer (Invitrogen) 12 hours after infection and subjected to SDS-polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis.
  • the proteins were transferred to a PVDF membrane in transfer buffer (100 mM Tris, 190 mM glycine).
  • transfer buffer 100 mM Tris, 190 mM glycine
  • the membranes were incubated with a rabbit anti-GFP polyclonal antibody (MBL) or rabbit antiserum to A/WSN/33(H1N1)(R309), which was available in our laboratory. This antiserum reacts with influenza viral proteins including HA, NP, and matrix protein (M1).
  • mice Pathogenicity and replication of viruses in mice.
  • Six-week-old female C57BL/6 mice were intranasally infected with 50 ⁇ L of 10 3 , 10 4 or 10 5 PFU of each virus.
  • Four mice per group were monitored for survival and body weight changes for 14 days after infection.
  • Three mice per group were infected with 10 3 PFU of each virus and euthanized on the indicated days.
  • Their lungs were collected to determine viral titers by means of plaque assay on MDCK cells.
  • Frozen sections (6 ⁇ m in thickness) were permeabilized in 0.2% Triton X-100 in PBS and incubated with primary antibodies at 4° C. for 12 hours.
  • Primary antibodies were goat anti-Clara cell 10 kDa protein (CC10) (Santa Cruz, sc-9772), rabbit anti-surfactant protein C (SP-C) (Santa Cruz, sc-13979), golden Syrian hamster anti-podoplanin (eBioscience, eBio8.1.1), and rabbit anti-calcitonin gene-related peptide (CGRP) (Sigma-Aldrich, C8198).
  • the sections were incubated with species-specific fluorescence dye-conjugated secondary antibodies at room temperature for 30 minutes. Nuclei were stained with Hoechst33342 (Invitrogen). A Nikon A1 confocal microscope (Nikon) was used to observe the sections.
  • Transparent samples were prepared by using SCALEVIEW A2 (Olympus) in accordance with a previous report (Hama et al., 2012).
  • SCALEVIEW A2 Orthogonal Activated Cell Sorting Protocol
  • Six-week-old female C57BL/6 mice were intranasally infected with 50 ⁇ L of 105 PFU of each virus. Intracardial perfusion was performed on the indicated days and lungs were fixed with 4% PFA in PBS for 4 hours at 4° C. Lungs were incubated with 10%, 20%, and 30% sucrose in PBS as described above, embedded in OCT compound, and frozen in liquid nitrogen. After the samples were thawed and rinsed in PBS, they were fixed again with 4% PFA in PBS for 30 minutes at room temperature.
  • SCALEVIEW A2 was exchanged every 2-3 days. Transparent samples were observed by using a stereo fluorescence microscope (Leica M205FA) mounted with a digital camera (DFC365FX) and filter GFP 3 (480/40 LP510).
  • Flow cytometry To prepare single-cell suspensions, lungs were minced with scissors and digested with 20 mg of collagenase D (Roche) and 200 units of DNase (Worthington) for 30 minutes at 37° C. Samples were then passed through 100-sm cell strainers and red blood cells were lysed by red blood cell lysis buffer (Sigma Aldrich).
  • RNA isolation and integrity RNA isolation and integrity. Venus-positive and -negative cells from three pooled lungs were collected in TRIzol Reagent (Invitrogen). Total RNA was extracted by isopropanol precipitation with glycogen as a carrier. Isolated total RNA integrity was assessed by determining UV 260/280 absorbance ratios and by examining 28S/18S ribosomal RNA bands with an Agilent 2100 bioanalyzer (Agilent Technologies) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
  • RNA sample was amplified by using the Arcturus® Riboamp® Plus RNA Amplification Kit (Life technologies). Cy3-labeled complementary RNA probe synthesis was initiated with 100 ng of total RNA by using the Agilent Low Input Quick Amp Labeling kit, one color (Agilent Technologies) according to the manufacturer's instructions. The Agilent SurePrint G3 Gene Mouse GE 8 ⁇ 60 K microarray was also used. Slides were scanned with an Agilent's High-Resolution Microarray Scanner, and image data were processed by using Agilent Feature Extraction software ver. 10.7.3.1. All data were subsequently uploaded into GeneSpring GX ver 12.5 for data analysis.
  • each gene expression array data set was normalized to the in silico pool for samples from mice inoculated with PBS.
  • Statistically significant differences in gene expression between the Venus-positive cells and -negative cells were determined by using one-way analysis of variance (ANOVA) followed by the Turkey HSD post-hoc test (P ⁇ 0.05) and the Benjamin-Hochberg false discovery rate correction.
  • Differentially expressed genes were further filtered to include genes whose expression changed 2.0-fold relatively to the level in the PBS group.
  • Genes that passed the statistical analysis were further assigned to a gene ontology (GO) grouping.
  • NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT virus was successfully rescued by reverse genetics, this virus was avirulent in mice (MLD 50 : >10 5 PFU), and the expression of Venus was very weak in MDCK cells and in the lung sections of mice infected with this virus.
  • MLD 50 >10 5 PFU
  • Venus was very weak in MDCK cells and in the lung sections of mice infected with this virus.
  • the virus was serially passed in mice via intranasal infection with plaque-purified high Venus-expressing clones (see Examples I and II). After six serial passages, the virulence of the virus appeared to have increased; therefore, this mouse-adapted NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT virus was sequenced to look for mutations.
  • NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus The pathogenicity of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus was higher than that of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT virus (MLD 50 : 2.1 ⁇ 10W PFU). Furthermore, the Venus signal in the lungs from mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus was strong, whereas in the lung infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT and that infected with PR8, no Venus signal was detected (data not shown). NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA, therefore, showed promise as a useful reporter virus.
  • NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT virus grew to 10 6.5 PFU/mL
  • NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus grew to more than 10 8 PFU/mL, comparable to wild-type PR8 virus.
  • the viral titers of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 PB2 virus and NS1-Venus PR8 HA virus reached approximately 1075 PFU/mL, these were lower than that of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus. Therefore, the growth capability of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus was remarkably improved in MDCK cells, and the mutations in the PB2 and HA genes acted in an additive manner.
  • mice were infected with 10 5 , 10 4 or 10 3 PFU of these viruses and monitored their body weights and survival ( FIG. 15 ).
  • the body weights of the mice infected with 10 5 PFU of these viruses dramatically decreased and 1 out of 4 mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT virus and all of the mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus had to be euthanized during the observation period.
  • mice infected with 10 4 PFU of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus showed pronounced body weight loss, and 1 out of 4 mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus MA virus and 2 out of 4 mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 PB2 virus succumbed to their infection.
  • body weights of the mice infected with 10 4 PFU of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 HA and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT virus decreased slightly, all of the mice survived.
  • mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA decreased slightly, all of these mice also survived.
  • Mice infected with 10 3 PFU of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 HA showed little body weight loss, and all of the mice survived.
  • the viral titers of these viruses were determined in mouse lung ( FIG. 16 ). Mice were infected with 10 3 PFU of the viruses and lungs were collected on days 3, 5, and 7 after infection.
  • the maximum virus lung titer from mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 PB2 virus was >10 6 PFU/g, which was similar to that from mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus.
  • virus titers in lungs from mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 HA virus were significantly lower than those in lungs from mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus at all time points.
  • viruses were not detected in lungs from mice infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT at 7 days after infection. Taken together, these results demonstrate that only the PB2 mutation affected the pathogenicity and replication of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus in mice.
  • Manicassamy study Manicassamy et al., 2010
  • the proportion of GFP-negative virus increased over time. This is one of the obstacles to utilizing this virus for live imaging studies.
  • the stability of Venus expression by NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus was assessed during replication in MDCK cells ( FIG. 17A ). More than 90% of plaques were Venus-positive even 72 hours after infection. The positive rate of Venus expression was monitored during repeated passages of the virus in cell culture ( FIG. 17B ). Approximately 90% of plaques expressed Venus even after 5 passages, suggesting that Venus expression by NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus was stable in cell culture.
  • the PB2 ⁇ E712D substitution is responsible for high Venus expression.
  • the Venus expression level of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus was substantially higher than that of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT virus. Since PB2 is one of the subunit of the influenza virus polymerase, it was hypothesized that the PB2 ⁇ E712D substitution was important for the augmentation of Venus expression. To compare the Venus protein expression, western blots of the viral protein and Venus in infected cells were performed ( FIG. 18A ).
  • PB2 ⁇ E712D mutation increased the Venus expression levels
  • MDCK cells were infected with the indicated viruses at an MOI of 1 and performed confocal microscopy 12 hours later ( FIG. 18C ).
  • the levels of the NS1 ⁇ Venus fusion protein were higher in cells infected with MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 or PB2-Venus ⁇ PR8 than in those infected with WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 or HA-Venus ⁇ PR8 ( FIG. 18C ).
  • HEK293 cells were transfected with viral protein expression plasmids for NP, PA, PB1, and PB2 or PB2 ⁇ E712D, together with a plasmid expressing a vRNA encoding the firefly luciferase gene; the pRL-null luciferase protein expression plasmid (Promega) served as a transfection control.
  • Luciferase activities were measured by using a Dual-Glo luciferase assay system (Promega) at 48 hours post-transfection (Ozawa et al., 2007).
  • the polymerase activity of PB2 ⁇ E712D was lower than that of the parental PB2 ( FIG. 18D ).
  • Similar results were obtained with canine MDCK cells (data not shown).
  • the PB2 ⁇ E712D mutation is thus attenuating; in contrast, this mutation enhances viral growth in the context of replicating virus.
  • the HA ⁇ T380A substitution raises the threshold for membrane fusion.
  • the HA vRNA of MA ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 did not significantly increase the virulence of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 in mice; however, HA-Venus ⁇ PR8 virus grew more efficiently in MDCK cells than WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 ( FIG. 14 ), suggesting a contribution of the HA-T380A mutation to, at least, virus replication in cultured cells.
  • the HA ⁇ T380A substitution is located on an a-helix in the HA2 subunit (Gamblin et al., 2004), its effect on HA membrane-fusion activity was evaluated by using a polykaryon formation assay (Imai et al., 2012).
  • HEK293 cells were infected with WT ⁇ PR8 or a mutant PR8 virus encoding HA ⁇ T380A at an MOI of 10. Eighteen hours later, cells were treated with TPCK-treated trypsin (1 ⁇ g/mL) for 15 minutes at 37° C., exposed to low-pH buffer (145 mM NaCl, 20 mM sodium citrate (pH 6.0-5.4)) for 2 minutes, incubated for 2 hours in maintenance medium at 37° C., fixed with methanol, and stained with Giemsa's solution. The wild-type HA had a threshold for membrane fusion of pH 5.5, whereas the threshold for HA ⁇ T380A was pH 5.8 ( FIG.
  • NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus allows the observation of virus-infected cells without immunostaining because the Venus expression by this virus is sufficiently high to permit the visualization of infected cells with a microscope.
  • SCALEVIEW A2 a reagent that make samples optically transparent without decreasing fluorescence intensity were used ( FIG. 20 ). Mice were intranasally infected with 105 PFU of PR8, NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 WT, and NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus, and lungs were collected on days 1, 3, and 5 after infection. After treatment with SCALEVIEW A2, the samples were observed using a stereo fluorescence microscope.
  • NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus Identification of the target cells of NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus in mouse lung.
  • Transparent lungs infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus revealed that influenza virus first infected the bronchial epithelium and subsequently invaded the alveoli over time.
  • an immunofluorescence assay of frozen sections was performed using several antibodies specific for lung cells ( FIG. 21 ).
  • the epithelial cells of the bronchi and bronchioles include Clara cells, ciliated cells, goblet cells, and a small number of neuroendocrine cells, whereas alveoli comprise type I and type II alveolar epithelial cells.
  • Flow cytometry was performed to determine whether alveolar macrophages and monocytes were infected with NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus, because these immune cells are present in lung and function as the first line of defense against inhaled microbes and particulates.
  • Alveolar macrophages were distinguished monocytes on the basis of the CD11b expression level in the F4/80 + population ( FIG. 22A ). Mice were infected with 105 PFU of PR8 or NS1 ⁇ Venus PR8 MA virus and the total number of these cells were compared. After influenza virus infection, although the number of alveolar macrophages was rarely different from that of the control group, the number of monocyte dramatically increased because monocytes infiltrated sites of infection from blood vessels ( FIGS.
  • Live mononuclear cells were gated as CD45 + and via-probe ⁇ cells. As shown in FIG. 22A , the cells were confirmed as alveolar macrophages and monocytes on the basis of CD11b expression levels in the F4180 + population.
  • Venus-positive and -negative F4/80 cells were sorted from a fraction of the live mononuclear cells by FACSAria II. Since CD11c high alveolar macrophages possess high autofluorescence, the possibility existed for overlap with the Venus signal. Therefore, CD11c high alveolar macrophages with intermediate expression of Venus were excluded from the Venus-positive fraction ( FIG. 23A ). From confocal microscopic observation of the sorted cells, these cells could be collected properly based on Venus expression ( FIG.
  • cytokine activity For genes annotated in “cytokine activity,” a total of 24 genes had changed expression levels, including several cytokines, such as type I interferon (IFN), and chemokines ( FIG. 24C ). All of these genes except for the genes for interleukin (IL)-4 and Cxcl13 [chemokine (C—X—C motif) ligand 13] were up-regulated in Venus-positive cells relative to Venus-negative cells.
  • IFN type I interferon
  • chemokines FIG. 24C
  • a vector is described above that can express a heterologous gene product from a fusion construct with the viral NS1 protein ( FIG. 26 ).
  • a PB2 ⁇ E712D mutation stabilized expression of a heterologous gene product.
  • the test virus, WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8, was serially passaged to identify other mutations in the polymerase complex which contribute to stabilization ( FIG. 27 ).
  • Madin-Darby canine kidney (MDCK) cells were cultured in minimal essential medium (Gibco) with 5% newborn calf serum at 37° C. in 5% CO 2 .
  • Human embryonic kidney 293T (HEK293T) cells were cultured in Dulbecco's modified Eagle medium supplemented with 10% fetal calf serum.
  • WT-Venus ⁇ PR8 and Venus ⁇ PR8 mutants with NS segments encoding the Venus fluorescent protein (Fukuyama et al., 2015) were generated by using reverse genetics (Neumann et al., 1999) and propagated in MDCK cells at 37° C.
  • MDCK cells were infected with WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 or each Venus ⁇ PR8 mutant at an MOI of 0.001. The supernatants were collected at 48 h postinfection and titrated by using plaque assays in MDCK cells. Obtained viruses were similarly passaged four times. The proportion of Venus-expressing plaques in virus stocks from different passages was determined in MDCK cells by observing more than 65 plaques in each virus stock using fluorescence microscopy. To exclude false-positive plaques, Venus-negative plaques were picked up, amplified in MDCK cells, and reassessed for Venus expression.
  • Deep sequencing analysis WT ⁇ PR8, PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D, PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ V43I (Cheung et al., 2014; Naito et al., 2015), and PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ T123A (Pauly et al., 2017) were generated by reverse genetics (Neumann et al., 1999), and MDCK cells were infected at an MOI of 0.001. The supernatants were collected at 48 h postinfection and titrated by using plaque assays in MDCK cells. The obtained viruses were passaged five times in the same way. Virus RNA was extracted from viruses before passaging and from viruses passaged five times by using a QIAamp viral RNA minikit (Qiagen).
  • RT-PCR Reverse transcription-PCR
  • DNA amplicons were purified by 0.45 ⁇ of Agencourt AMpure XP magnetic beads (Beckman Coulter), and 1 ng was used for barcoded library preparation with a Nextera XT DNA kit (Illumina).
  • Nextera XT DNA kit Illumina
  • libraries were sequenced on the MiSeq platform in a paired-end run using the MiSeq v2, 300 cycle reagent kit (Illumina).
  • the raw sequence reads were analyzed by using the ViVan pipeline (Isakov et al., 2015). Here, a cutoff of 1% as the minimum frequency was used.
  • RNA samples were infected with WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 or Venus ⁇ PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D at an MOI of 1 or mock infected with medium.
  • the total RNA was extracted from cells at 9 h postinfection by using an RNeasy minikit (Qiagen). Quantification of RNA was performed as described previously (Kawakami et al., 2011).
  • the primers for IFN- ⁇ , NS vRNA, NP vRNA, and ⁇ -actin were described previously (Kawakami et al., 2011; Kupke et al., 2018; Park et al., 2015).
  • Data were analyzed with the 2 ⁇ CT method (Livak et al., 2001) and normalized to the expression of ⁇ -actin mRNA.
  • MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1 or mock infected with medium. Cells were lysed at the indicated time points with Tris-glycine SDS sample buffer (Invitrogen). The cell lysates were sonicated, heated for 10 min at 95° C., and then subjected to SDS-PAGE. SDS-PAGE was performed on Any kD Mini-PROTEAN TGX precast protein gels (Bio-Rad).
  • Proteins on SDS-PAGE gels were transferred to a polyvinylidene fluoride membrane (Millipore) and detected by using the indicated primary antibodies (rabbit anti-NS1 [GeneTex], mouse anti-Aichi NP [2S 347/4], mouse anti-R-actin [Sigma-Aldrich]), followed by secondary antibodies (sheep horseradish peroxidase [HRP]-conjugated anti-mouse IgG [GE Healthcare] or donkey HRP-conjugated anti-rabbit IgG [GE Healthcare]). Signals of specific proteins were detected by using ECL Prime Western blotting detection reagent (GE Healthcare).
  • PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ V43I which has been reported to be a high-fidelity mutant virus (Cheung et al., 2014; Naito et al., 2015), and PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ T123A, which has been reported to be a low-fidelity mutant virus (Pauly et al., 2017), were also generated by reverse genetics and used as controls. To estimate the mutation rates, these viruses were passaged in MDCK cells at an MOI of 0.001 and deep sequencing of the entire genome performed; the sequencing data for the five-times passaged viruses were compared to those of viruses before passaging. The number of nucleotide changes in the five-times passaged viruses that were not present before passaging were counted.
  • the number of mutations introduced during the five passages are shown in FIG. 29A by segment. Also, the number of mutations per nucleotide was calculated for normalization, and the mean values for all eight segments were compared ( FIG. 29B ). It was confirmed that PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ V43I, the high-fidelity control, had fewer mutations, and that PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ T123A, the low-fidelity control, had more mutations than WT ⁇ PR8. Although PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ V43I had fewer mutations than WT ⁇ PR8, the difference between PR8 ⁇ PB1 ⁇ V43I and WT ⁇ PR8 was small.
  • WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 induced a higher level of IFN- ⁇ expression than did Venus ⁇ PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D ( FIG. 30A ). This result suggests that WT-Venus ⁇ PR8 does not efficiently inhibit IFN- ⁇ expression.
  • NS1 plays a key role in suppressing IFN expression and IFN-mediated antiviral responses in the host (Garcia-Sastre et al., 1998; Opitz et al., 2007)
  • the NS vRNA in infected cells was quantified by using influenza virus strand-specific real-time PCR (Kawakami et al., 2011; Kupke et al., 2018).
  • the amount of NS vRNA in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8-infected cells was 90% lower than that in Venus ⁇ PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D-infected cells ( FIG. 30B ), whereas there was no significant dierence in their NP vRNA expression levels ( FIG. 30C ).
  • the NS vRNA/NP vRNA ratio in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8-infected cells was 80% lower than that in Venus ⁇ PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D-infected cells ( FIG. 30D ). This result suggests that the transcription/replication of the NS segment is specifically impaired in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8.
  • the expression level of the NS1 protein in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8-infected cells was much lower than that in Venus ⁇ PR8 ⁇ PB2 ⁇ E712D-infected cells.
  • the expression level of NP was almost the same.
  • the NS1/NP ratio, quantified based on the band intensity, was significantly reduced in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8-infected cells ( FIG. 30F ). It therefore appears that the low level of NS1 expression leads to the high expression of IFN- ⁇ in WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8-infected cells.
  • the high expression of IFN- ⁇ causes attenuation of WT-Venus ⁇ PR8, although it is possible that other factors are involved.
  • the Inserted Venus Gene is Deleted Via Internal Deletion.
  • PA-180 and PA-200 are located in the endonuclease domain, PB1-149 and PB1-684 are located near the exit of the RNA template, and PB2-540 is located near the exit of newly synthesized RNA products ( FIG. 32B ), while the function of the region around PB2-712 has remained unclear (Reich et al., 2014; Pflug et al., 2017; Gerlach et al., 2015). To determine whether these mutations contribute to the stabilization of the Venus gene, mutant viruses were generated containing each of the mutations by using reverse genetics and measured the Venus retention ratio after four passages in MDCK cells ( FIG. 32C ).
  • the mutant viruses showed enhanced Venus stability compared to WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8, indicating that these amino acids play roles in the stabilization of the Venus gene.
  • PB2-540, PB1-149, and PB1-684 are located near the polymerase internal tunnels (Reich et al., 2014; Pflug et al., 2017; Gerlach et al., 2015) that the template and product go through during the transcription/replication reaction, these amino acids may affect the binding stability of the RNA template, product, and polymerase complex.
  • FIG. 32D when we examined whether these mutations were found in previously isolated influenza A viruses in the Influenza Research Database ( FIG. 32D ), we found that these amino acids are extremely rare, suggesting that they are not evolutionarily beneficial.
  • WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 in which the Venus gene is inserted into the NS segment, the transcription/replication efficiency of this segment is significantly reduced. As a result, the expression of the NS1 protein is also reduced. Since NS1 plays a role in inhibiting IFN-mediated antiviral responses (Garcia-Sastre et al., 2008; Optiz et al., 2007) WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 cannot inhibit IFN-(3 expression efficiently, which may lead to virus attenuation. The viral titer of WT ⁇ Venus ⁇ PR8 increases during serial passages in MDCK cells as the virus loses Venus expression ( FIGS.
  • RNA secondary structure and the binding affinity between the polymerase complex and the RNA templates likely hold the answer to these questions. Insertion of a foreign gene must change the RNA secondary structure, and transcription/replication by the viral polymerase complex may be negatively influenced by this unusual RNA secondary structure.
  • PB2 ⁇ E712D mutation overcomes the impairment of transcription/replication, one possible explanation is that the binding affinity between the polymerase complex and the RNA templates is increased.
  • Additional mutations in the influenza virus polymerase complex were identified that stabilize the inserted Venus gene, which may help us to further understand the stabilization mechanisms based on the positions of these mutations in the viral polymerase complex.
  • Some of the identified amino acids are located near the polymerase internal tunnels, which are near the RNA template or newly synthesized RNA product during the transcription/replication reactions (Reich et al., 2014; Pflug et al., 2017; Gerlach et al., 2015). These amino acids might directly affect the binding affinity between the polymerase complex, template, and product.
  • amino acids may not necessarily cause the stabilization of a foreign gene in all influenza virus strains, since PB2-V25A, which stabilizes the Venus gene in Venus ⁇ H5N1, had a negative effect on virus replication in Venus ⁇ PR8 and did not cause Venus stabilization (our unpublished data).

Abstract

The disclosure provides for an isolated recombinant influenza virus having at least one of: a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 634 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 635 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, and methods of making and using the virus.

Description

    CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 16/749,910, filed on Jan. 22, 2020, which claims the benefit of the filing date of U.S. application Ser. No. 62/795,821, filed on Jan. 23, 2019, the disclosure of which is incorporated by reference herein.
  • STATEMENT OF GOVERNMENT RIGHTS
  • This invention was made with government support under HHSN272201400008C awarded by the National Institutes of Health. The government has certain rights in the invention.
  • BACKGROUND
  • Influenza A virus is a respiratory pathogen that causes annual epidemics and sporadic pandemics (Wright et al., 2013). Moreover, highly pathogenic avian H5N1 and the recently emerged H7N9 influenza viruses have caused an appreciable number of human infections with high mortality rates (Watanabe et al., 2013; Zhang et al., 2013). Influenza viruses infect respiratory epithelial cells and alveolar macrophages in mammalian hosts (Yu et al., 2010). The host immune system recognizes the RNA genome of influenza viruses via cytosolic sensors (Diebold et al., 2004; Pichlmair et al., 2006), which trigger innate immune responses that lead to the production of type I interferons (IFNs) and proinflammatory cytokines and chemokines (Honda and Taniguchi, 2006). Type I IFNs upregulate the production of antiviral proteins including myxovirus resistance (Mx), oligoadenylate synthetase (OAS), and interferon-stimulated gene 15 (ISG15) (Garcia-Sastre et al., 2011). Dysregulation of the innate immune responses to influenza virus infection causes lung pathology mediated by infiltrating immune cells, including macrophages and neutrophils (Heron et al., 2008; Perrone et al., 2008). Although several studies have addressed host responses to influenza virus infections (Fakuyama and Kawaoka, 2011), the mechanisms of influenza virus-induced pathology are still not fully understood.
  • To analyze the immune responses to influenza virus infection in vivo, viruses have been generated that expressed a fluorescent reporter protein (Kittel et al., 2004; Shinya et al., 2004). However, these viruses were significantly attenuated (Kittel et al., 2004; Shinya et al., 2004) and may not accurately reflect natural infections. For example, Manicassamy et al. (2010) generated a GFP-expressing influenza virus, which they used to assess the route of antigen presentation upon influenza virus infection (Helft et al., 2012). However, the GFP gene was not stably maintained during replication in mouse lung or cultured cells (Manicassamy et al., 2010).
  • Highly pathogenic avian influenza viruses (HPAI) of the H5N1 subtype continue to evolve in nature, threatening animal and public health. These viruses were first identified in Guangdong province in China in 1996 (Li et al., 2006), and have since been found in over 63 countries in multiple avian species, repeatedly infecting mammals such as pigs and humans (Li et al., 2010; Neumann et al., 2010). By December 2013, 648 human cases of H5N1 virus infection had been confirmed by the World health organization (WHO), of which 384 were fatal, yielding a mortality rate of almost 60% (http://www.who.int). In addition, novel subtypes of influenza viruses, such as H7N9 and H10N8 virus, have spontaneously appeared and sporadically infected humans causing fatal outcomes (Chen et al., 2014; Li et al., 2013) (http://www.who.int). Thus, the current threat from influenza viruses reminds us of the urgent need to gain a thorough understanding of their pathogenic mechanism in order to develop more effective strategies for control, including dynamic processes of influenza virus infection and virus-target cells in vivo remain unclear.
  • SUMMARY
  • The present disclosure relates to mutations in influenza virus viral segment(s) that increase genetic; stability, for instance, of an additional, non-influenza viral gene, such as a “heterologous” gene sequence that is inserted into one of the viral segments, e.g., fused to an intact or modified (for example, truncated or internally deleted) viral protein coding region, or that is present on an additional viral segment. In one embodiment, one or more of the mutations may be employed to enhance the stability of influenza viruses that are not augmented with heterologous gene sequences. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is a marker gene, e.g., a fluorescent protein gene such as one for GFP, BFP, RFP, or YFP, a luciferase gene, a beta-glucuronidase gene, or beta-lactamase gene. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is for a prophylactic gene product. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence encodes a therapeutic gene product.
  • As disclosed herein, influenza viruses expressing fluorescent proteins of different colors (Color-flu viruses) were generated. Viruses containing the foreign matter gene were passaged. Upon adaptation to mice, stable expression of the fluorescent proteins in infected animals allowed their detection by different types of microscopy and by flow cytometry. The use of fluorescent influenza viruses, each of which stably expresses one of four different fluorescent proteins, allows for simultaneous monitoring and live imaging Using these viruses, several studies were performed to demonstrate the versatility of these viruses. For example, this system was used to analyze the progression of viral spread in mouse lungs, for live imaging of virus-infected cells, and for differential gene expression studies in virus antigen-positive and -negative live cells in the lungs of Color-flu-infected mice. Thus, Color-flu viruses are powerful tools to analyze virus infections at the cellular level in vivo to better understand influenza pathogenesis. Moreover, different stabilizing mutations in the resulting viruses were identified. These mutations include the T380A in HA protein (numbering is that for H1) and E712D in PB2 protein of A/PR/8/34 (H1N1) virus, and V25A, R443K, K737R and P167S amino acid replacements in the PB2, PA, PB1 and NS1 proteins of A/Vietnam/1203/2004 (H5N1) virus, respectively. The individual mutations in the H5 virus alone resulted in the virus containing a foreign gene more stable in vitro, and the combination of all of them provided even greater stability in vivo. These mutations are useful for any HA/NA combination.
  • In one embodiment, a recombinant virus has one or more stabilizing mutations, e.g., one or more substitutions in one or more influenza virus proteins that enhance the stability or replication (for instance, enhance the titer) of the recombinant virus with the one or more substitutions relative to a corresponding virus without the one or more substitutions (a parental virus) and/or one or more substitutions in one or more influenza virus proteins that enhance the stability or replication of a heterologous gene sequence present on one of the viral segments in the recombinant virus relative to a corresponding virus without the one or more substitutions that has the heterologous gene sequence in the respective viral segment and/or one or more substitutions in one or more influenza virus proteins that enhance the stability or replication of a heterologous gene sequence that is present on an additional viral segment in the recombinant virus relative to a corresponding virus without the one or more substitution and that has the additional viral segment with the heterologous gene sequence. The one or more substitutions include but are not limited to substitutions in any of influenza PA, PA-X, PB1, PB1-F2, PB2, NP, NS1, NS2, M1, M2, NA, and/or HA (e.g., a HA of influenza A virus), substitutions encoded in the corresponding viral segments therefor (PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and/or HA), or a combination of substitutions in any one of those influenza virus proteins or genes, or a combination of one or more substitutions in two or more of those proteins or genes. In one embodiment, the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the PA protein, e.g., a substitution for glutamine at position 180, for threonine at position 200, or for arginine at position 443 in PA (which is located on the protein surface) that enhances, for example, RNA replication, PA proteolytic activity and/or interaction with one or more viral or cellular proteins. In one embodiment, the substitution for arginine at position 443 in PA is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for arginine at position 443 in PA is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamine at position 180 in PA is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamine at position 180 in PA is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for threonine at position 200 in PA is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for threonine at position 200 in PA is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the PB2 protein, e.g., a substitution for valine at position 25, a substitution for asparagine at position 540, and/or for glutamic acid at position 712 in PB2 that, for example, enhances polymerase activity, interaction with MAVS (for position 25) and/or protein folding or stability (for position 712). In one embodiment, the substitution for valine at position 25 in PB2 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for valine at position 25 in PB2 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for asparagine at position 540 in PB2 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for asparagine at position 540 in PB2 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamic acid at position 712 in PB2 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamic acid at position 712 in PB2 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the PB1 protein, e.g., a substitution for valine at position 149, for lysine at position 737, for glutamic acid at position 684, and/or for aspartic acid at position 685, in PB1 (which may be located on the protein surface) that, for instance, alter polymerase or endonuclease activity. In one embodiment, the substitution for lysine at position 737 in PB1 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for lysine at position 737 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for valine at position 149 in PB1 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for valine at position 149 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamic acid at position 684 in PB1 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for glutamic acid at position 684 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for aspartic acid at position 685 in PB1 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for aspartic acid at position 685 in PB1 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication, e.g., by altering the interferon interfering activity or transcription regulatory activity of NS1 of an influenza virus, are in the NS1 protein, e.g., a substitution for proline at position 167 in NS1 which may alter interaction with cellular proteins. In one embodiment, the substitution for proline at position 167 in NS1 is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for proline at position 167 in NS1 is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the one or more substitutions that enhance the stability or replication of an influenza virus are in the HA protein, e.g., a substitution for threonine at position 380 in HA (which is in an alpha helix of HA-2). In one embodiment, the substitution for threonine at position 380 in HA is a conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the substitution for threonine at position 380 in HA is a non-conservative substitution. In one embodiment, the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R. In one embodiment, the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G. In one embodiment, the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D. In one embodiment, the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T.
  • The viruses may be employed as vaccines or as gene delivery vectors.
  • The vectors comprise influenza cDNA, e.g., influenza A (e.g., any influenza A gene including any of the 18 HA or 11 NA subtypes), B or C DNA (see Fields Virology (Fields et al. (eds.), Lippincott, Williams and Wickens (2006), which is specifically incorporated by reference herein).
  • In one embodiment, PB1, PB2, PA, NP, M, and NS encode proteins having at least 80%, e.g., 90°/c, 92%, 95%, 97%, 98%, or 99%, including any integer between 80 and 99, contiguous amino acid sequence identity to, a polypeptide encoded by one of SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15, although the disclosed positions and substitutions in viral proteins may be made in a viral segment from any influenza virus isolate or may be used to select viral segments with specified residues at the one or more disclosed positions. In one embodiment, PB1, PB2, PA, NP, M, and NS encode proteins that are having at least 80%, e.g., 90%, 92%, 95%, 97%, 98%, or 99%, including any integer between 80 and 99, contiguous amino acid sequence identity to, a polypeptide encoded by one of SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15. In one embodiment, the influenza virus polypeptide has one or more, for instance, 2, 5, 10, 15, 20 or more, conservative amino acids substitutions, e.g., conservative substitutions of up to 10% or 20% of 2, 5, 10, 15, 20 or more, of a combination of conservative and non-conservative amino acids substitutions, e.g., conservative substitutions of up to 10% or 20% of the residues, or relative to a polypeptide encoded by one of SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15, and has a characteristic residue as described herein that provides for stability.
  • A recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in a recombinant virus, such as a reassortant virus, having one or more stabilizing mutations in one or more influenza virus proteins. For example, a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 200 that is not threonine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid may be selected; a PB2 viral segment encoding a PB2 with a residue at position 25 that is not valine, a residue that is not asparagine at position 540, or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid may be selected; a NS viral segment encoding a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline may be selected; or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V. In one embodiment, the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R. In one embodiment, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L. In one embodiment, the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N. In one embodiment, the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G. In one embodiment, the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 167 in NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T. In one embodiment, the residue at position 380 in HA is A, I, V, L or G.
  • In one embodiment, the influenza virus of the disclosure is a recombinant influenza virus having two or more of selected amino acid residues at specified positions in one or more of PA, PB1, PB2, HA, and/or NS1. In one embodiment, the recombinant reassortant influenza virus has a lysine or histidine at position 443 in PA, a histidine or arginine at position 737 in PB1, a leucine, isoleucine, threonine, alanine or glycine at position 25 in PB2 and/or an aspartic acid, histidine, arginine, lysine or asparagine at position 712 in PB2; a leucine, alanine, valine, isoleucine, or glycine at position 380 in HA, or serine, cysteine, methionine, alanine, valine, glycine, isoleucine or leucine at position 167 in NS1.
  • A recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure having an extra viral segment with a heterologous gene sequence (a “9 segment” virus) which virus has enhanced stability and/or replication may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in the recombinant virus having one or more of the stabilizing mutations in an influenza virus protein. For example, a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected; a PB2 viral segment encoding a PB2 with a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid may be selected; a NS viral segment enclosing a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline may be selected; or any combination thereof. The extra viral segment may be derived from any of the naturally occurring viral segments. In one embodiment, the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R. In one embodiment, the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G. In one embodiment, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V. In one embodiment, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L. In one embodiment, the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N. In one embodiment, the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D. In one embodiment, the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T. The heterologous gene sequence may be of length that results in the viral segment with that heterologous gene sequence having a length that is up to 4 kb, 4.2 kb, 4.5 kb, 4.7 kb, 5 kb, 5.2 kb, 5.5 kb, 5.7 kb or 6 kb in length. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene in the extra viral segment replaces influenza virus protein coding sequences (e.g., there is a deletion of influenza virus coding sequences without deleting encapsidation (incorporation) sequences in coding sequences that are linked to encapsidation sequences in non-coding sequences at one or both ends of the viral segment). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is in genomic orientation. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is fused in frame to N-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is fused in frame to C-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences. The heterologous gene may encode a RNA, e.g., a microRNA, or a protein, e.g., a gene product that is prophylactic or therapeutic. In one embodiment, the gene product is an antigen from a different influenza virus isolate, or an antigen from a bacteria, a virus other than influenza virus, a parasite, or a fungus.
  • A recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure having a heterologous gene sequence in one of the eight viral segments (an “8 segment” virus) with enhanced stability and/or replication may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in the recombinant virus having one or more of the stabilizing mutations in an influenza virus protein. For example, a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected; a PB2 viral segment encoding a PB2 with a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid may be selected; a NS viral segment enclosing a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline may be selected; or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R. In one embodiment, the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G. In one embodiment, the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D. In one embodiment, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V. In one embodiment, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L. In one embodiment, the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N. In one embodiment, the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H. In one embodiment, the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T.
  • A recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure having a heterologous gene sequence in one of the influenza virus viral segments that also lacks a viral segment (a “7 segment” virus), which virus has enhanced stability and/or replication, may be prepared by selecting viral segments for inclusion in the recombinant virus having one or more of the stabilizing mutations in an influenza virus protein. For example, a HA viral segment encoding a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine may be selected; a PA viral segment encoding a PA with a residue at position 443 that is not arginine may be selected; a PB1 viral segment encoding a PB1 with a residue at position 737 that is not lysine may be selected; a PB2 viral segment encoding a PB2 with a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid may be selected; a NS viral segment enclosing a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline may be selected; or any combination thereof. The viral segment that is omitted may be any one of the naturally occurring viral segments and optionally the encoded protein is provided in trans. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PA viral segment, or the PA protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 443 in PA is K or H. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the PB1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 737 in PB1 is H or R. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB2 viral segment, or the PB2 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 25 in PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB2 viral segment, or the PB2 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 712 in PB2 is D. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PA viral segment, or the PA protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PA viral segment, or the PA protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 200 in PA is A, G, I, L or V. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the PB1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, G, I or L. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the PB1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 684 in PB1 is D or N. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB1 viral segment, or the P protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a PB2 viral segment, or the PB2 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 540 in PB2 is K, R or H. In one embodiment, the 7 segment virus includes a NS viral segment, or the NS1 protein is provided in trans, and the residue at position 167 in NS1 is C, M, A, L, I, G or T. The heterologous gene sequence may be of length that results in the viral segment with that heterologous gene sequence having a length that is up to 4 kb, 4.2 kb, 4.5 kb, 4.7 kb, 5 kb, 5.2 kb, 5.5 kb, 5.7 kb or 6 kb in length. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene replaces influenza virus protein coding sequences (e.g., there is a deletion of influenza virus coding sequences without deleting encapsidation (incorporation) sequences in coding sequences that are linked to encapsidation sequences in non-coding sequences at one or both ends of the viral segment). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is in genomic orientation. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is fused in frame to N-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence in the extra viral segment is fused in frame to C-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences. The heterologous gene may encode a RNA, e.g., a microRNA, or a protein, e.g., a gene product that is prophylactic or therapeutic. In one embodiment, the gene product is an antigen from a different influenza virus isolate, or an antigen from a bacteria, a virus other than influenza virus, a parasite, or a fungus.
  • The heterologous gene sequence may be inserted into any viral segment. The heterologous gene sequence may be of length that results in the viral segment with that heterologous gene sequence having a length that is up to 4 kb, 4.2 kb, 4.5 kb, 4.7 kb, 5 kb, 5.2 kb, 5.5 kb, 5.7 kb or 6 kb in length. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene replaces internal influenza virus sequences in the viral segment. In one embodiment, the insertion of a heterologous gene sequence may result in a “knock-out” of the respective influenza virus gene product and to prepare such a virus, influenza virus protein(s) may be provided in trans to complement that type of mutation. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequences are in addition to influenza virus coding sequences in the viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is fused in frame to N-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene in is fused in frame to C-terminal influenza virus protein coding sequences. The heterologous gene may encode a RNA or a protein, e.g., a gene product that is prophylactic or therapeutic. In one embodiment, the gene product is an antigen from a different influenza virus isolate, an antigen from a bacteria, a virus other than influenza virus, a parasite, or a fungus. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the NA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the HA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the M viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the NP viral segment, e.g., see Liu et al., 2012; Wang et al. 2010; Arilor et al., 2010; Dos Santos Afonso et al., 2005). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the PA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is in the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment (see, e.g., Avilov et al. 2012). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NS coding sequence in the NS viral segment (Manicassamy et al. 2010). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NS2 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the HA coding sequence in the HA viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the NA coding sequence in the NA viral segment (see, e.g., Perez et al. 2004). In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the M1 coding sequence in the M viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence is 5′ or 3′ to, replaces at least some of or is inserted into, the M2 coding sequence in the M viral segment (see, e.g., Wei et al. 2011).
  • Further provided is a vaccine comprising the recombinant virus of the disclosure, e.g., a live attenuated vaccine or where the recombinant virus is cold adapted, one or more vectors comprising one or more viral segments with one or more of the disclosed substitutions, as well as methods of making and using the recombinant virus. In one embodiment, the vector for vRNA production comprises a promoter such as a RNA polymerase I promoter, a RNA polymerase II promoter, a RNA polymerase III promoter, a T3 promoter or a T7 promoter.
  • Also provided is a method to generate influenza viruses with an altered property, e.g., enhanced replication or stability, in a selected avian or mammalian host. The method includes serially passaging an isolate of an influenza virus in an individual host organism, and identifying individual viruses with the altered property and optionally molecularly characterizing the individual viruses.
  • Further provided is a set of recombinant influenza viruses, each member of the set encoding a distinct optically detectable marker, e.g., the open reading frame of which is fused to the open reading frame of an influenza virus protein, the open reading frame of which is on a ninth viral segment for influenza A or B viruses, or the open reading frame of which replaces at least a portion of one of the viral protein coding regions. For example, one of the members includes a luminescent protein gene, e.g., a luciferase gene, a fluorescent protein gene, for instance, green fluorescent protein gene, yellow fluorescent protein gene, or red fluorescent protein gene, photoprotein genes such as Aequorin photoprotein gene or obelin photoprotein gene, chloramphenical acetyltransferase gene, a phosphatase gene such as alkaline phosphatase gene, a peroxidase gene such as horseradish peroxidase gene, beta-galactosidase gene, beta-lactamase gene or beta-glucuronidase gene.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES
  • FIGS. 1A-1G. Characteristics of mouse-adapted Venus−PR8 in mice. (A-F) Four B6 mice per group were intranasally inoculated with WT−PR8, WT−Venus−PR8, or MA−Venus−PR8. Body weight and survival of mice were monitored for 14 days. (G) Lungs of animals infected with 104 PFU of PR8 or MA−Venus PR8 (three mice per group) were harvested at days 3, 5, and 7 p.i. Virus titers were analyzed by use of a plaque assay in MDCK cells.
  • FIGS. 2A-2C. Distribution of Color-flu viruses in lungs. (A) Lung tissues were harvested from B6 mice at days 3 and 5 p.i. with Color-flu viruses (105 PFU of MA−eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry−PR8). The open reading frame (ORF) of the NS1 gene without a stop codon was fused with the N-terminus of fluorescent reporter genes (Venus, eCFP, eGFP, and mCherry) via a sequence encoding the protein linker GSGG. The fluorescent genes are followed by a sequence encoding the GSG linker, a foot-and-mouth virus protease 2A autoproteolytic site with 57 nucleotides from porcine teschovirus-1, and by the ORF of NEP. In addition, silent mutations were introduced into the endogenous splice acceptor site of the NS1 ORF to prevent splicing. Whole-mount images of transparent lung tissues were obtained by using a fluorescent stereomicroscope. (B, C) B6 mice were intranasally inoculated with a mixture of MA−eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry-PR8 (2.5×104 PFU per strain). Scale bar, 5 mm. (B) The sections of lungs at days 2 and 5 p.i. were analyzed by using an inverted fluorescence microscope with a Nuance FX multispectral imaging system with InForm software. Scale bar, 100 μm. (C) Enlarged images of the indicated area in (B) were unmixed and separated into autofluorescence (AF), eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry fluorescence. Arrows in the merged image indicate cells infected with different color variants of Color-flu viruses.
  • FIGS. 3A-3K. Analysis of macrophage infiltration. (A-D) Lung tissues were harvested from PBS-inoculated mice (mock) or mice infected with 105 PFU of MA−Venus−PR8 at day 2 p.i., and tissues were fixed and processed for histological analysis. Sections were incubated with PE-anti-Mac3 antibody to detect macrophages (red) and counterstained with Hoechst dye (blue) to visualize nuclei. The fluorescent signal of the Venus protein is shown in green. The scale bar represents 200 μm. (E-H) Kinetics of the interaction between virus infected cells and lung macrophages. Images of eGFP positive cells (green) and CD11b+ macrophage (red) in lung tissue from naïve B6 mice (upper left panel) and B6 mice on day 3 p.i. with 105 PFU MA−eGFP−PR8 (upper right panel) were obtained by using two-photon microscope. Sequential images in lower panel (1-4) show an enlarged view of the box in the upper right panel. Arrowheads indicate the blebbing of eGFP positive cells. Scale bar. 40 μm. (l) Infection of macrophages by influenza viruses. Single cell suspensions were obtained from lungs of PBS-inoculated (mock) mice or mice infected with 105 PFU of MA−Venus−PR8 at day 3 p.i., stained with antibodies against CD45, CD11b, and F4/80, and analyzed by flow cytometry. The panel shows Venus expression versus the CD11b staining profile from cells gated on F4/80 and CD45 expression levels. (J) Gene expression analysis. Total RNA was isolated from sorted macrophages of PBS-inoculated (naive) mice, and from sorted Venus-positive (Venus(+)) and Venus-negative (Venus(−)) macrophages of mice inoculated with 105 PFU of MA−Venus−PR8 at day 3 p.i. (9 mice per treatment), and microarray analysis was performed. (J) Differentially expressed (DE) transcripts were identified by comparing gene expression levels in naive macrophages with those in Venus(+) macrophages from infected mice. Likewise, gene expression levels were compared for naive macrophages and Venus(−) macrophages obtained from infected mice. DE transcripts were organized by hierarchical clustering and each cluster was analyzed for enriched biological functions. A heat map of the clustered transcripts for each condition is displayed (a color key is shown at the top of the panel), and the different clusters are illustrated by the color bar on the left of the heat map. Enriched annotations for each cluster are listed to the left of each cluster, with the enrichment score for each annotation in parentheses. The blue line in the heat map illustrates fold changes of DE transcripts when comparing Venus(+) with Venus(−) macrophages. A shift of the blue line to the left indicates that the DE transcript is more highly expressed in Venus(+) macrophages, whereas a shift to the right indicates that the DE transcript is more highly expressed in Venus(−) macrophages. (K) This panel shows a heat map comparing expression levels of type I interferons (IFNs) between Venus(+) and Venus(−) macrophages. A color key is shown at the bottom of the panel. NS denotes comparisons that were not statistically significant between Venus(−) cells from infected animals and naive macrophages from uninfected animals.
  • FIGS. 4A-4E. Characterization of MA−Venus−HPAI virus. (A) Four B6 mice per group were intranasally inoculated with MA−Venus−HPAI virus. Mouse body weight and survival were monitored for 14 days. (B) Lungs, spleens, kidneys, and brains were harvested from B6 mice at day 3 p.i. with 105 PFU of MA−Venus−HPAI virus. Virus titers of tissue homogenates were determined by use of plaque assays in MDCK cells. Each data point represents mean±s.d. (n=3) (C, D) Lung tissues were harvested from B6 mice at day 1 and day 2 p.i. with 105 PFU of MA−Venus−HPAI virus and PR8. Images of transparent lung tissues (bronchus, red; alveolar, green) were obtained by a two-photon microscope. Each data point represents mean±s.d. (n=3). Statistical significance was calculated using the Student's t-test. (D) The distribution of Venus-positive cells was evaluated via volume analysis of the Venus-positive bronchus and alveolar area using 3D images of the transparent lung tissues. (E) Cells were collected from lungs of B6 mice at days 1, 2, 3, and 4 p.i. with 105 PFU of MA−Venus−PR8 or MA−Venus−HPAI virus, and stained for CD45, CD11b, and F4/80. Venus expression in CD45-negative cells, and the Venus versus F4/80 staining profile gated on CD45-positive cells were analyzed by flow cytometry. A representative data plot form day 2 p.i. is shown with the percentage of Venus-positive cells.
  • FIG. 5. Virus yield of various viruses.
  • FIGS. 6A-6D. Virulence of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus and RG−MA virus in mice. Groups of four mice were intranasally infected with WT−Venus−H5N1 virus at doses of 101 to 105 PFU or with RG−MA virus at doses of 100 to 105 PFU, and their body weight changes (A-C) and survival (B-D) were monitored for two weeks.
  • FIG. 7. Venus expression of various H5N1 viruses in MDCK cells. MDCK cells were infected with Venus−H5N1-related viruses, and at 24 hpi the Venus expression of each virus plaque was observed by using fluorescent microscopy (Axio Observer.Z1, Zeiss). A representative image of each virus is shown.
  • FIG. 8. Venus expression of various H5N1 viruses in mouse lung. Groups of three mice were intranasally infected with 105 PFU (50 μl) of virus. The mice were euthanized on day 2 p.i., and their lungs were collected and fixed in 4% PFA and then embedded in O.C.T Compound. The frozen tissues were cut into 5-μm slices and then stained with Hoechst 33342. Venus signal was detected by using the Nikon confocal microscope system A1+. Blue represents nuclei stained by Hoechst 33342; green represents Venus expression.
  • FIG. 9. Genotypes of Venus−H5N1-related reassortants and their virulence in mice. The colors indicate the origins of the viral segments: blue, WT−Venus−H5N1 virus; red, MA−Venus−H5N1 virus. MLD50 values were determined by inoculating groups of four mice with 10-fold serial dilutions contain 100 to 105 PFU of virus in a 50-μL volume and were calculated by using the method of Reed and Muench (30).
  • FIG. 10. Growth kinetics of reassortants in MDCK cells. MDCK cells were infected with virus at an MOI of 0.0001, and culture supernatants were collected at the indicated times and then titrated in MDCK cells. The reported values are means±standard deviations (SD) from two independent experiments. *, P<0.01 compared with that of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus-infected cells.
  • FIG. 11. Polymerase activity of different RNP combinations derived from the WT−Venus−H5N1 and MA−Venus−H5N1 viruses. 293 cells were transfected in triplicate with a luciferase reporter plasmid and an internal control plasmid, together with plasmids expressing PB1, PB2, PA, and NP from either WT−Venus−H5N1 or MA−Venus−H5N1 virus. Segments derived from WT−Venus−H5N1 virus are shown in white, whereas those derived from MA−Venus−H5N1 virus are in green. Cells were incubated at 37° C. for 24 hours, and cell lysates were analyzed to measure firefly and Renilla luciferase activities. The values shown are means±SD of the three independent experiments and are standardized to the activity of WT−Venus−H5N1 (100%). *, P<0.05 compared with that of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus. *, P<0.01 compared with that of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus.
  • FIG. 12A. Venus-NS and deleted NS segments of Venus−H5N1-related reassortants. Viruses were passaged five times in MDCK cells and the vRNAs from the fifth passages were extracted by using a QIAamp® Viral RNA Mini Kit (QIAGEN). The respective NS segments were then amplified by using PCR with NS-specific primers and run on an agarose gel. Lane 1, WT+MA−NS; lane 2, WT+MA−M; lane 3, WT+MA−NA; lane 4, WT+MA−PA; lane 5, WT+MA−PB1; lane 6, WT+MA−PB2; lane 7, WT+MA−(PB2+PA); lane 8, WT−Venus−H5N1; lane 9, RG−MA; lane 10, PR8; and lane 11, 1-kb DNA marker.
  • FIG. 12B. Schematic of deleted viruses.
  • FIG. 13. High expression of Venus reassortants in mouse lung.
  • FIG. 14. Comparison of the growth capabilities of mutant viruses in MDCK cells. MDCK cells were infected at a MOI of 0.001 with PR8, NS1−Venus PR8 WT, NS1−Venus PR8 MA, and mutant NS1−Venus PR8 viruses that possess amino acid substitutions found in NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus. Virus titers were determined every 12 hours by means of plaque assays. Results are expressed as the mean titer (log10 [PFU/ml])±standard deviation.
  • FIG. 15. Body weight changes and survival rates for mice infected with viruses carrying Venus. Four mice per group were intranasally infected with 103, 104 and 105 PFU of each NS1−Venus PR8 virus. Body weights were measured and survival rates were monitored for 14 days after infection.
  • FIGS. 16A-16B. Virus titers in mouse lung. Nine mice per group were intranasally infected with 103 PFU of PR8 (A) or the respective NS1−Venus PR8 virus (B). Three mice per group were euthanized on days 3, 5, and 7 after infection and their lungs collected to determine virus titers. Virus titers were determined by means of plaque assays. Results are expressed as the mean of the titer (log10 PFU/g)±standard deviation. Statistical significance was calculated by using the Tukey-Kramer method. Asterisks indicate significant differences from titers from mice infected with PR8 or NS1−Venus WT virus (P<0.05). ND: Not detected (detection limit, 5 PFU/lung).
  • FIG. 17. The stability of Venus expression by NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus in vitro and in vivo. The positive rate of Venus expression was examined in MDCK cells and in mouse lung. Left panel: MDCK cells were infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus at an MOI of 0.001, and supernatants were collected every 24 hours. The positive rate of Venus expression was estimated by dividing the number of plaques that expressed Venus by the total number of plaques. Middle panel: NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus was serially passaged in MDCK cells five times and the positive rates of Venus expression were estimated. Right panel: Nine mice were infected with 103 PFU of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus. Three mice were euthanized at each time point and plaque assays were performed using lung homogenates. The positive rates of Venus expression were estimated as described above.
  • FIGS. 18A-18G. Comparison of Venus expression in cells infected with each NS1−Venus PR8 virus. (A-B) Venus protein expression in cells infected with each NS1−Venus PR8 virus was detected by means of western blotting. MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1. Twelve hours after infection, virus-infected cells were lysed and western blotting was performed. An anti-GFP antibody was used to detect Venus protein, and M1 protein was detected as a control. The bands appeared at approximately 27 kDa were shown in M1 panel. Representative results of two independent experiments are shown. (C-F) Observation of Venus expression by use of confocal microscopy. MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1. Twelve hours after infection, cells were fixed, and Venus expression was observed. Representative results of two independent experiments are shown. Indicated viruses were used to infect MDCK cells (MOI of 1) and confocal microscopy was performed 12 hours later. (G) HEK293 cells were infected with viral protein expression plasmids for NP, PA, PB1 and PB2 or PB-2−E712D, together with a plasmid expressing a vRNA encoding firefly luciferase.
  • FIG. 19. Polykaryon formation by HEK293 cells infected with wild-type PR8 or PR8 that possesses the HA−T380A mutation after exposure to low pH buffer. The threshold for membrane fusion was examined at a pH range of 5.5-5.9. HEK293 cells were infected with PR8 or PR8 that possesses the HA−T380A substitution. Eighteen hours after infection, HA on the cell surface was digested with TPCK-trypsin, and exposure to the indicated pH buffer. After fixation with methanol, the cells were stained with Giemsa's solution. Representative pictures are shown.
  • FIG. 20. Time-course observation of Venus-expressing cells in transparent lungs. Venus-expressing cells in whole lung lobe were observed. Three mice per group were intranasally infected with NS1-Venus PR8 MA, NS1−Venus PR8 WT or PR8 virus and lungs were collected on the indicated days. Mock-treated lungs served as a negative control. To image Venus-expressing cells deeper, lung samples were treated with SCALEVIEW A2, which make samples transparent, and were separated into each lobe and observed by using a stereo fluorescence microscope. After imaging the whole lung lobe (intact), samples were dissected to exposure the bronchi (cut). Samples from mice infected with PR8 or NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus were prepared on day 3 post-infection to compare with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus-infected lungs in which the Venus signal was the brightest during infection. Representative images are shown.
  • FIGS. 21A-21B. Analysis of Venus expression in CC10+ cells and SP-C+ cells in lungs. Lung sections from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus were stained with several antibodies specific for the epithelial cells in the lung. Mice were infected with 104 PFU of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 and 5 days post-infection. (A) Lung section of mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus were prepared at 3 days post-infection and stained with an anti-CC10 polyclonal antibody (red). Scale bar: 100 μm. (B) Lung section of mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus were prepared at 5 days post-infection and stained with an anti-SP-C polyclonal antibody (cyan) and an anti-podoplanin (Pdpn) polyclonal antibody (red). Venus-positive cells in the alveolar region comprised SP-C-positive cells (white arrowhead) and podoplanin-positive cells (white arrow). Scale bar: 50 μm.
  • FIGS. 22A-22E. Flow cytometric analysis of Venus-positive cells in specific cell types of the lung. Venus-positive cells in the indicated cell types were analyzed by using flow cytometry. Mice were infected with 105 PFU of PR8 or NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 and 5 days post-infection. Single cell suspensions were stained with antibodies. (A) Representative dot plot for CD45+ live cells from the lung of mice inoculated with PBS are shown. (B, C) Total numbers of each specific cell species at the indicated time points are shown. Results are expressed as the mean cell numbers per lung±standard deviation. CD45+ and via-probe cells were analyzed for monocytes and alveolar macrophages. (D, E) The numbers of Venus-positive cells in cells defined in A and B at the indicated time points are shown. Results are expressed as the mean cell numbers±standard deviation. AM: alveolar macrophage.
  • FIGS. 23A-23B. Sorting strategy to collect Venus-positive and Venus-negative cells in the F4/80+ population. Mice were infected with 105 PFU of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 days post-infection. Single cell suspensions were stained with a set of antibodies. Lungs from mice inoculated with PBS were similarly stained to confirm the autofluorescence of alveolar macrophages. (A) Representative dot plots showing the gating strategy to collect Venus-positive and -negative cells in a population of CD45+, via-probe F4/80+ cells. The Venus-positive gate was shown not to include alveolar macrophages. (B) Venus-positive and -negative cells collected from the lungs of mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus were observed by using an immunofluorescence assay.
  • FIGS. 24A-24D. Genes differentially expressed between Venus-positive and -negative F4/80+ cells. Mice were infected with 105 PFU of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus and lungs were collected at 3 days post-infection. Single cell suspensions were stained in the same manner as described in FIG. 10. Venus-positive and -negative cells were separately harvested by using FACSAria II and subjected to microarray analysis. F4/80+ cells isolated from the lungs of mice inoculated with PBS were used as a control. (A) A total of 633 genes were selected by student's T test (P<0.05) and by filtering the genes whose expression changed at least 4.0-fold between the Venus-positive and -negative groups from the genes whose expression changed at least 2.0-fold from the level of the PBS group. (B) These selected genes were functionally annotated by using Gene Ontology (GO) grouping. Statistical significance were determined by using Fisher's exact test (P<0.01). (C) Hierarchical analysis of genes annotated in “cytokine activity” enriched by genes that were significantly differentially expressed between Venus-positive and -negative F4/80+ cells. (D) Hierarchical analysis of genes annotated in “response to wounding” enriched by genes that were significantly differentially expressed between Venus-positive and -negative F4/80+ cells.
  • FIGS. 25A-25M. Exemplary parental sequences for PR8HG and the Cambridge strain of PR8 (SEQ ID Nos: 1-19).
  • FIG. 26. Schematic of fusion protein comprising a heterologous protein.
  • FIG. 27. Schematic of mutations in polymerase complex proteins that stabilize heterologous gene products mapped on the structure of the complex (PDB ID:4WSB).
  • FIGS. 28A-28C. A) Schematic structure of the eight viral RNA segments contained in WT−Venus−PR8. 2A, protease 2A autoproteolytic site. (B) Each virus was passaged in MDCK cells. The proportion of Venus-expressing plaques in virus stocks from different passages was determined in MDCK cells by using fluorescence microscopy. (C) The virus stocks from different passages were titrated by use of plaque assays in MDCK cells.
  • FIGS. 29A-29B. Effect of PB2−E712D on the mutation rate. (A) Each virus was passaged five times in MDCK cells, and the mutations introduced into each segment during the passages were counted. (B) The mutation number per nucleotide in each segment was calculated, and the mean values for all eight segments are shown.
  • FIGS. 30A-30F. RNA and protein expression in infected cells. (A to C) MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1. The relative expression levels of IFN-β mRNA (A), NS vRNA (B), and NP vRNA (C) were determined by quantitative real-time PCR at 9 h postinfection. (D) The NS vRNA/NP vRNA ratio was calculated. (E) MDCK cells were infected with WT−Venus−PR8 (WT) or Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D (712) at an MOI of 1. Cells were lysed at the indicated time points, and the expression of NS1, NP, and β-actin was detected by Western blotting. (F) NS1/NP ratios were determined based on the band intensity of the Western blotting. Means±the standard deviations of triplicate experiments, taking each value in Venus−PR8-PB2−E712D-infected cells as 1, are shown in panels A, B. C, D, and F. *, P<0.01; ns, not significant (Student t test); hpi, hours postinfection.
  • FIGS. 31A-31C. Internal deletions occurred in the NS segment of WT−Venus−PR8. (A) Schematic sequence of the NS segment in WT−Venus−PR8 viruses that lost Venus expression after serial passages in MDCK cells. Selected examples are shown. (B) The procedure for the coinfection experiment is illustrated. The synonymous mutation was introduced into the 3′ or 5′ region of the NS segment of WT−Venus−PR8. The viruses were then used to coinfect MDCK cells. Viruses not expressing Venus were plaque purified, and the sequences of their NS segments were analyzed. (C) Examples of the sequences of the NS segment of Venus-negative viruses obtained after coinfection experiments. The red “X” indicates an introduced synonymous mutation.
  • FIGS. 32A-32D. Additional mutations that stabilizes the Venus gene inserted into the NS segment. (A) Identified amino acid mutations were mapped onto the influenza polymerase complex (PDB ID 4WSB). (B) Polymerase internal tunnels (shown as yellow tubes). The vRNA promoter binds to the polymerase, and the template vRNA enters the polymerase complex. The template vRNA passes through the active site, where RNA synthesis occurs, and then leaves via the template exit. The RNA products synthesized at the active site, leave via the product exit. (C) Each mutant Venus−PR8 virus was passaged four times in MDCK cells, and the proportion of Venus-expressing plaques after passaging was determined in MDCK cells by using fluorescence microscopy. (D) Percentages of influenza A virus strains containing mutations that stabilize the Venus gene in Venus−PR8 (i.e., the number of strains containing the indicated amino acid/total number of strains available in the Influenza Research Database).
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION Definitions
  • As used herein, the term “isolated” refers to in vitro preparation and/or isolation of a nucleic acid molecule, e.g., vector or plasmid, peptide or polypeptide (protein), or virus of the disclosure, so that it is not associated with in vivo substances, or is substantially purified from in vitro substances. An isolated virus preparation is generally obtained by in vitro culture and propagation, and/or via passage in eggs, and is substantially free from other infectious agents.
  • As used herein, “substantially purified” means the object species is the predominant species, e.g., on a molar basis it is more abundant than any other individual species in a composition, e.g., is at least about 80% of the species present, and optionally 90% or greater, e.g., 95%, 98%, 99% or more, of the species present in the composition.
  • As used herein, “substantially free” means below the level of detection for a particular infectious agent using standard detection methods for that agent.
  • A “recombinant” virus is one which has been manipulated in vitro, e.g., using recombinant DNA techniques, to introduce changes to the viral genome. Reassortant viruses can be prepared by recombinant or nonrecombinant techniques.
  • As used herein, the term “recombinant nucleic acid” or “recombinant DNA sequence or segment” refers to a nucleic acid, e.g., to DNA, that has been derived or isolated from a source, that may be subsequently chemically altered in vitro, so that its sequence is not naturally occurring, or corresponds to naturally occurring sequences that are not positioned as they would be positioned in the native genome. An example of DNA “derived” from a source, would be a DNA sequence that is identified as a useful fragment, and which is then chemically synthesized in essentially pure form. An example of such DNA “isolated” from a source would be a useful DNA sequence that is excised or removed from said source by chemical means, e.g., by the use of restriction endonucleases, so that it can be further manipulated, e.g., amplified, for use in the invention, by the methodology of genetic engineering.
  • As used herein, a “heterologous” influenza virus gene or viral segment is from an influenza virus source that is different than a majority of the other influenza viral genes or viral segments in a recombinant, e.g., reassortant, influenza virus.
  • The terms “isolated polypeptide”, “isolated peptide” or “isolated protein” include a polypeptide, peptide or protein encoded by cDNA or recombinant RNA including one of synthetic origin, or some combination thereof.
  • The term “recombinant protein” or “recombinant polypeptide” as used herein refers to a protein molecule expressed from a recombinant DNA molecule. In contrast, the term “native protein” is used herein to indicate a protein isolated from a naturally occurring (i.e., a nonrecombinant) source. Molecular biological techniques may be used to produce a recombinant form of a protein with identical properties as compared to the native form of the protein.
  • Methods of alignment of sequences for comparison are well known in the art. Thus, the determination of percent identity between any two sequences can be accomplished using a mathematical algorithm.
  • Computer implementations of these mathematical algorithms can be utilized for comparison of sequences to determine sequence identity. Alignments using these programs can be performed using the default parameters. Software for performing BLAST analyses is publicly available through the National Center for Biotechnology Information (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/). The algorithm may involve first identifying high scoring sequence pairs (HSPs) by identifying short words of length W in the query sequence, which either match or satisfy some positive-valued threshold score T when aligned with a word of the same length in a database sequence. T is referred to as the neighborhood word score threshold. These initial neighborhood word hits act as seeds for initiating searches to find longer HSPs containing them. The word hits are then extended in both directions along each sequence for as far as the cumulative alignment score can be increased. Cumulative scores are calculated using, for nucleotide sequences, the parameters M (reward score for a pair of matching residues; always >0) and N (penalty score for mismatching residues; always <0). For amino acid sequences, a scoring matrix is used to calculate the cumulative score. Extension of the word hits in each direction are halted when the cumulative alignment score falls off by the quantity X from its maximum achieved value, the cumulative score goes to zero or below due to the accumulation of one or more negative-scoring residue alignments, or the end of either sequence is reached.
  • In addition to calculating percent sequence identity, the BLAST algorithm may also perform a statistical analysis of the similarity between two sequences. One measure of similarity provided by the BLAST algorithm may be the smallest sum probability (P(N)), which provides an indication of the probability by which a match between two nucleotide or amino acid sequences would occur by chance. For example, a test nucleic acid sequence is considered similar to a reference sequence if the smallest sum probability in a comparison of the test nucleic acid sequence to the reference nucleic acid sequence is less than about 0.1, less than about 0.01, or less than about 0.001.
  • The BLASTN program (for nucleotide sequences) may use as defaults a wordlength (W) of 11, an expectation (E) of 10, a cutoff of 100, M=5, N=−4, and a comparison of both strands. For amino acid sequences, the BLASTP program may use as defaults a wordlength (W) of 3, an expectation (E) of 10, and the BLOSUM62 scoring matrix. See http://www.ncbi.n1m.nih.gov. Alignment may also be performed manually by inspection.
  • For sequence comparison, typically one sequence acts as a reference sequence to which test sequences are compared. When using a sequence comparison algorithm, test and reference sequences are input into a computer, subsequence coordinates are designated if necessary, and sequence algorithm program parameters are designated. The sequence comparison algorithm then calculates the percent sequence identity for the test sequence(s) relative to the reference sequence, based on the designated program parameters.
  • “Conservative” amino acid substitutions refer to the interchangeability of residues having similar side chains. For example, a group of amino acids having aliphatic side chains is glycine, alanine, valine, leucine, and isoleucine; a group of amino acids having aliphatic-hydroxyl side chains is serine and threonine; a group of amino acids having amide-containing side chains is asparagine and glutamine; a group of amino acids having aromatic side chains is phenylalanine, tyrosine and tryptophan; a group of amino acids having basic side chains is lysine, arginine and histidine; and a group of amino acids having sulfur-containing side chain is cysteine and methionine. In one embodiment, conservative amino acid substitution groups are: threonine-valine-leucine-isoleucine-alanine; phenylalanine-tyrosine; lysine-arginine; alanine-valine; glutamic-aspartic; and asparagine-glutamine.
  • Encapsidation Sequences
  • The viral segment for incorporation of heterologous gene sequences into a recombinant influenza virus includes at each end non-coding sequences that provide for encapsidation (incorporation or packaging) into virions. The viral segments also include adjacent coding sequences, from one or both ends, that contribute to encapsidation, e.g., enhance encapsidation relative to viral segments that lack the adjacent coding sequences but have with the heterologous gene sequence. The vectors with the viral segment having the heterologous gene sequence thus include encapsidation sequences that at the 3′ end of vRNA that may include adjacent 5′ coding sequences, at the 5′ end of vRNA that may include 3′ coding sequences, or at the 3′ end of vRNA that may include adjacent 5′ coding sequences and at the 5′ end of vRNA that may include 3′ coding sequences. For example, HA encapsidation sequences include sequences at the 3′ end of HA vRNA including 33-nt of non-coding sequences and at least 3, 6, 9, or 15 or up to about 216 nt of HA coding sequence and/or at the 5′ end of HA vRNA including about 45 nt of non-coding sequence and up to about 75, 80, 268 or 291 of HA coding sequence (Watanabe et al. 2003). HS encapsidation sequences include sequences at the 3′ end of NS vRNA including at least 30, 60, 90 or 150 nt of coding sequence and at the 5′ end of NS vRNA including at least 30, 60, 90 or 100 nt of coding sequence (Fujii et al. 2005).
  • In one embodiment, the 3′ NA incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 183, nucleotides 1 to 90, nucleotides 1 to 45, nucleotides 1 to 21, nucleotides 1 to 19 or any integer between 19 and 183, of the N-terminal NA coding region, and may include a mutation at the NA initiation codon. In another embodiment, the 5′ NA incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of NA, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 39, 78, or 157, or any integer between 1 and 157, nucleotides for C-terminal NA coding region.
  • In one embodiment, the 5′ HA incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of HA, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 75, 80, 268, 291, or 518, or any integer between 1 and 518, nucleotides of the C-terminal HA coding region. The 3′ HA incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 3, 1 to 6, 1 to 9, 1 to 15, 1 to 216, 1 to 468, or any integer between 1 and 468, of the N-terminal HA coding region.
  • In one embodiment, the 3′ PB1 or PB2 incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 160 or 1 to 130 or any integer between 1 and 250, of the N-terminal PB1 or PB2 coding region. In one embodiment, the 5′ PB1 or PB2 incorporation sequences correspond to the 3′ most nucleotides, e.g., the 3′ 1 to 250 nucleotides, 1 to 200 nucleotides, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 160, 1 to 170 or 1 to 190, or any integer between 1 and 250, of the C-terminal PB1 or PB2 coding region.
  • In one embodiment, the 3′ PA incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, or any integer between 1 and 250, of the N-terminal PA coding region. In one embodiment, the 5′ PA incorporation sequences correspond to the 3′ most nucleotides, e.g., the 3′ 1 to 250 nucleotides, 1 to 200 nucleotides, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 160, 1 to 170 or 1 to 190, or any integer between 1 and 250, of the C-terminal PA coding region.
  • In one embodiment, the 3′ M incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 242, nucleotides 1 to 240 or any integer between 1 and 250, of the N-terminal M coding region, and may include a mutation at the M initiation codon. In another embodiment, the 5′ M incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of M, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 50, 100, or 220, or any integer between 1 and 250, nucleotides for C-terminal M coding region.
  • In one embodiment, the 3′ NS or NP incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 30, or any integer between 1 and 250, e.g., 1 to 60, 1 to 70, 1 to 80 or 1 to 90 of the N-terminal NS or NP coding region, and may include a mutation at the NS or NP initiation codon. In another embodiment, the 5′ NS or NP incorporation sequences correspond to sequences in the C-terminal coding region of NS or NP, sequences corresponding to the 3′ most 10, 30, 150, 200 or 250, or any integer between 1 and 250, nucleotides for the C-terminal NS or NP coding region, e.g., nucleotides 1 to 250, nucleotides 1 to 200, nucleotides 1 to 150, nucleotides 1 to 30, or any integer between 1 and 250, e.g., 1 to 60, 1 to 70, 1 to 80 or 1 to 90 of the C-terminal NS or NP codon region.
  • Accordingly, the disclosure provides influenza virus vectors which include sequences corresponding to the 3′ and 5′ noncoding regions of a particular vRNA, incorporation sequences of the corresponding vRNA, and a heterologous nucleic acid segment. Thus, in one embodiment, the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of NA vRNA, 3′ or 5′ NA vRNA incorporation sequences, and optionally both 3′ and 5′ NA incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of NA vRNA. In another embodiment, the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of HA vRNA, 5′ or 3′ HA vRNA incorporation sequences or both 5′ and 3′ HA incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of HA vRNA. In another embodiment, the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of NS vRNA, NS incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of NS vRNA. In another embodiment, the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of M vRNA, 5′ or 3′ M incorporation sequences or both 5′ and 3′ M incorporation sequences, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, and the 5′ noncoding region of M vRNA. In yet another embodiment, the vector includes the 3′ noncoding region of PB2 vRNA, a heterologous nucleic acid segment, PB2 incorporation sequences, and the 5′ noncoding region of PB2 vRNA. When two incorporation sequences are employed in a vector, they may be separated by the heterologous nucleic acid segment. Each vector may be employed so as to prepare vRNA for introduction to a cell, or to express vRNA in a cell, in which other influenza virus vRNAs and proteins necessary for virus production, are present.
  • In another embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence comprises sequences corresponding to an open reading frame for a therapeutic gene. In yet a further embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence comprises sequences corresponding to an open reading frame for an immunogenic peptide or protein of a pathogen or a tumor cell, e.g., one useful to induce a protective immune response. For example, the heterologous nucleic acid segment may encode an immunogenic epitope useful in cancer therapy or a vaccine. The vector comprising the heterologous nucleic acid segment may be prepared such that transcription of vector vRNA results in mRNA encoding a fusion protein with an influenza protein such as NA. Thus, it is envisioned that the heterologous nucleic acid segment may be fused with viral incorporation sequences so as to encode a fusion protein, e.g., a fusion with the N-terminal 21 residues of NA. The fusion protein may comprise sequences from two different influenza virus proteins including sequences from two different NA or HA proteins. In another embodiment, the heterologous nucleic acid segment may comprise sequences corresponding to an IRES linked 5N to an open reading frame.
  • In one embodiment of the disclosure, the heterologous gene sequence may encode a heterologous protein (a non-influenza viral protein such as a glycoprotein or a cytosolic, nuclear or mitochondrial specific protein), which may confer a detectable phenotype. In one embodiment, the heterologous gene sequence may be fused to truncated portions of PB2 coding sequences, e.g., those corresponding to 5′ or 3′ PB2 coding incorporation sequences, optionally forming a chimeric protein. In one embodiment, the heterologous nucleotide sequence replaces or is introduced to sequences in the viral viral segment corresponding to the coding region for that segment, so as not to disrupt the incorporation sequences in the coding region of the viral segment. For instance, the heterologous nucleotide sequence may be flanked by about 3 to about 400 nucleotides of the 5′ and/or 3′ PB2 coding region adjacent to non-coding sequence. In one embodiment, the 3′ PB2 incorporation sequences correspond to nucleotides 3 to 400, nucleotides 3 to 300, nucleotides 3 to 100, nucleotides 3 to 50, or any integer between 3 and 400, of the N-terminal and/or C-terminal PB2 coding region. In one embodiment, after infection of a host cell with the biologically contained PB2-KO virus, a heterologous protein is produced which is a fusion with the N-terminus and/or C-terminus of the remaining residues of the deleted PB2 protein.
  • The vRNA for the additional viral segment or a viral segment having the heterologous gene sequence may be incorporated into virions at an efficiency that is at least 1%, 5%, 10%, or 30%, or at least 50%, that of a corresponding wild-type vRNA.
  • Influenza Virus Structure and Propagation
  • Influenza A viruses possess a genome of eight single-stranded negative-sense viral RNAs (vRNAs) that encode at least ten proteins. The influenza virus life cycle begins with binding of the hemagglutinin (HA) to sialic acid-containing receptors on the surface of the host cell, followed by receptor-mediated endocytosis. The low pH in late endosomes triggers a conformational shift in the HA, thereby exposing the N-terminus of the HA2 subunit (the so-called fusion peptide). The fusion peptide initiates the fusion of the viral and endosomal membrane, and the matrix protein (M1) and RNP complexes are released into the cytoplasm. RNPs consist of the nucleoprotein (NP), which encapsidates vRNA, and the viral polymerase complex, which is formed by the PA, PB1, and PB2 proteins. RNPs are transported into the nucleus, where transcription and replication take place. The RNA polymerase complex catalyzes three different reactions: synthesis of an mRNA with a 5′ cap and 3′ polyA structure, of a full-length complementary RNA (cRNA), and of genomic vRNA using the cRNA as a template. Newly synthesized vRNAs, NP, and polymerase proteins are then assembled into RNPs, exported from the nucleus, and transported to the plasma membrane, where budding of progeny virus particles occurs. The neuraminidase (NA) protein plays a crucial role late in infection by removing sialic acid from sialyloligosaccharides, thus releasing newly assembled virions from the cell surface and preventing the self-aggregation of virus particles. Although virus assembly involves protein-protein and protein-vRNA interactions, the nature of these interactions is largely unknown.
  • Although influenza B and C viruses are structurally and functionally similar to influenza A virus, there are some differences. For example, influenza B virus does not have a M2 protein with ion channel activity but has BM2 and has a viral segment with both NA and NB sequences. Influenza C virus has only seven viral segments.
  • Cell Lines that can be Used
  • Any cell, e.g., any avian or mammalian cell, such as a human, e.g., 293T or PER.C69 cells, or canine, e.g., MDCK, bovine, equine, feline, swine, ovine, rodent, for instance mink, e.g., MvLu1 cells, or hamster, e.g., CHO cells, or non-human primate, e.g., Vero cells, including mutant cells, which supports efficient replication of influenza virus can be employed to isolate and/or propagate influenza viruses. Isolated viruses can be used to prepare a reassortant virus. In one embodiment, host cells for vaccine production are continuous mammalian or avian cell lines or cell strains. A complete characterization of the cells to be used, may be conducted so that appropriate tests for purity of the final product can be included. Data that can be used for the characterization of a cell includes (a) information on its origin, derivation, and passage history; (b) information on its growth and morphological characteristics; (c) results of tests of adventitious agents; (d) distinguishing features, such as biochemical, immunological, and cytogenetic patterns which allow the cells to be clearly recognized among other cell lines; and (e) results of tests for tumorigenicity. In one embodiment, the passage level, or population doubling, of the host cell used is as low as possible.
  • In one embodiment, the cells are WHO certified, or certifiable, continuous cell lines. The requirements for certifying such cell lines include characterization with respect to at least one of genealogy, growth characteristics, immunological markers, virus susceptibility tumorigenicity and storage conditions, as well as by testing in animals, eggs, and cell culture. Such characterization is used to confirm that the cells are free from detectable adventitious agents. In some countries, karyology may also be required. In addition, tumorigenicity may be tested in cells that are at the same passage level as those used for vaccine production. The virus may be purified by a process that has been shown to give consistent results, before vaccine production (see, e.g., World Health Organization, 1982).
  • Virus produced by the host cell may be highly purified prior to vaccine or gene therapy formulation.
  • Generally, the purification procedures result in extensive removal of cellular DNA and other cellular components, and adventitious agents. Procedures that extensively degrade or denature DNA may also be used.
  • Influenza Vaccines
  • A vaccine of the disclosure includes an isolated recombinant influenza virus of the disclosure, and optionally one or more other isolated viruses including other isolated influenza viruses, one or more immunogenic proteins or glycoproteins of one or more isolated influenza viruses or one or more other pathogens, e.g., an immunogenic protein from one or more bacteria, non-influenza viruses, yeast or fungi, or isolated nucleic acid encoding one or more viral proteins (e.g., DNA vaccines) including one or more immunogenic proteins of the isolated influenza virus of the disclosure. In one embodiment, the influenza viruses of the disclosure may be vaccine vectors for influenza virus or other pathogens.
  • A complete virion vaccine may be concentrated by ultrafiltration and then purified by zonal centrifugation or by chromatography. Viruses other than the virus of the invention, such as those included in a multivalent vaccine, may be inactivated before or after purification using formalin or beta-propiolactone, for instance.
  • A subunit vaccine comprises purified glycoproteins. Such a vaccine may be prepared as follows: using viral suspensions fragmented by treatment with detergent, the surface antigens are purified, by ultracentrifugation for example. The subunit vaccines thus contain mainly HA protein, and also NA. The detergent used may be cationic detergent for example, such as hexadecyl trimethyl ammonium bromide (Bachmeyer, 1975), an anionic detergent such as ammonium deoxycholate (Laver & Webster, 1976); or a nonionic detergent such as that commercialized under the name TRITON X100. The hemagglutinin may also be isolated after treatment of the virions with a protease such as bromelin, and then purified. The subunit vaccine may be combined with an attenuated virus of the disclosure in a multivalent vaccine.
  • A split vaccine comprises virions which have been subjected to treatment with agents that dissolve lipids. A split vaccine can be prepared as follows: an aqueous suspension of the purified virus obtained as above, inactivated or not, is treated, under stirring, by lipid solvents such as ethyl ether or chloroform, associated with detergents. The dissolution of the viral envelope lipids results in fragmentation of the viral particles. The aqueous phase is recuperated containing the split vaccine, constituted mainly of hemagglutinin and neuraminidase with their original lipid environment removed, and the core or its degradation products. Then the residual infectious particles are inactivated if this has not already been done. The split vaccine may be combined with an attenuated virus of the disclosure in a multivalent vaccine.
  • Inactivated Vaccines. Inactivated influenza virus vaccines are provided by inactivating replicated virus using known methods, such as, but not limited to, formalin or β-propiolactone treatment. Inactivated vaccine types that can be used in the invention can include whole-virus (WV) vaccines or subvirion (SV) (split) vaccines. The WV vaccine contains intact, inactivated virus, while the SV vaccine contains purified virus disrupted with detergents that solubilize the lipid-containing viral envelope, followed by chemical inactivation of residual virus.
  • In addition, vaccines that can be used include those containing the isolated HA and NA surface proteins, which are referred to as surface antigen or subunit vaccines.
  • Live Attenuated Virus Vaccines. Live, attenuated influenza virus vaccines, such as those including a recombinant virus of the disclosure can be used for preventing or treating influenza virus infection. Attenuation may be achieved in a single step by transfer of attenuated genes from an attenuated donor virus to a replicated isolate or reassorted virus according to known methods. Since resistance to influenza A virus is mediated primarily by the development of an immune response to the HA and/or NA glycoproteins, the genes coding for these surface antigens come from the reassorted viruses or clinical isolates. The attenuated genes are derived from an attenuated parent. In this approach, genes that confer attenuation generally do not code for the HA and NA glycoproteins.
  • Viruses (donor influenza viruses) are available that are capable of reproducibly attenuating influenza viruses, e.g., a cold adapted (ca) donor virus can be used for attenuated vaccine production. See, for example, Isakova-Sivall et al., 2014. Live, attenuated reassortant virus vaccines can be generated by mating the ca donor virus with a virulent replicated virus. Reassortant progeny are then selected at 25° C. (restrictive for replication of virulent virus), in the presence of an appropriate antiserum, which inhibits replication of the viruses bearing the surface antigens of the attenuated ca donor virus. Useful reassortants are: (a) infectious, (b) attenuated for seronegative non-adult mammals and immunologically primed adult mammals, (c) immunogenic and (d) genetically stable. The immunogenicity of the ca reassortants parallels their level of replication. Thus, the acquisition of the six transferable genes of the ca donor virus by new wild-type viruses has reproducibly attenuated these viruses for use in vaccinating susceptible mammals both adults and non-adult.
  • Other attenuating mutations can be introduced into influenza virus genes by site-directed mutagenesis to rescue infectious viruses bearing these mutant genes. Attenuating mutations can be introduced into non-coding regions of the genome, as well as into coding regions. Such attenuating mutations can also be introduced into genes other than the HA or NA, e.g., the PB2 polymerase gene. Thus, new donor viruses can also be generated bearing attenuating mutations introduced by site-directed mutagenesis, and such new donor viruses can be used in the production of live attenuated reassortants vaccine candidates in a manner analogous to that described above for the ca donor virus. Similarly, other known and suitable attenuated donor strains can be reassorted with influenza virus to obtain attenuated vaccines suitable for use in the vaccination of mammals.
  • In one embodiment, such attenuated viruses maintain the genes from the virus that encode antigenic determinants substantially similar to those of the original clinical isolates. This is because the purpose of the attenuated vaccine is to provide substantially the same antigenicity as the original clinical isolate of the virus, while at the same time lacking pathogenicity to the degree that the vaccine causes minimal chance of inducing a serious disease condition in the vaccinated mammal.
  • The viruses in a multivalent vaccine can thus be attenuated or inactivated, formulated and administered, according to known methods, as a vaccine to induce an immune response in an animal, e.g., a mammal. Methods are well-known in the art for determining whether such attenuated or inactivated vaccines have maintained similar antigenicity to that of the clinical isolate or high growth strain derived therefrom. Such known methods include the use of antisera or antibodies to eliminate viruses expressing antigenic determinants of the donor virus; chemical selection (e.g., amantadine or rimantidine); HA and NA activity and inhibition; and nucleic acid screening (such as probe hybridization or PCR) to confirm that donor genes encoding the antigenic determinants (e.g., HA or NA genes) are not present in the attenuated viruses.
  • Exemplary Embodiments
  • A reporter influenza virus, e.g., allowing visualization of virus-infected cells to understand influenza virus-induced pathology, was prepared by inserting the gene for the Venus fluorescent protein into the NS segment of influenza A/Puerto Rico/8/34 (PR8, H1N1) virus to yield WT−Venus−PR8. Although the inserted Venus gene was deleted during serial passages of WT−Venus−PR8, and WT−Venus−PR8 was significantly attenuated, the PB2−E712D mutation was found to stabilize the Venus gene. As disclosed herein, the mechanisms by which Venus gene deletion occurs and how the polymerase mutation stabilizes the Venus gene were investigated. Deep sequencing analysis revealed that PB2−E712D does not cause an appreciable change in the mutation rate, suggesting that the stability of the Venus gene is not affected by polymerase fidelity. Using quantitative real-time PCR it was found that WT−Venus−PR8 induces high-level interferon beta (IFN-β) expression. The induction of IFN-β expression seemed to result from the reduced transcription/replication efficiency of the modified NS segment in WT−Venus−PR8. In contrast, the transcription/replication efficiency of the modified NS segment was enhanced by the PB2−E712D mutation. Loss of the Venus gene in WT−Venus−PR8 appeared to be caused by internal deletions in the NS segment. Moreover, to further the understanding of the Venus stabilization mechanisms, additional amino acid mutations in the virus polymerase complex were identified that stabilize the Venus gene. It was found that some of these amino acids are located near the template exit or the product exit of the viral polymerase, suggesting that these amino acids contribute to the stability of the Venus gene by affecting the binding affinity between the polymerase complex and the RNA template and product.
  • The disclosure provides an isolated recombinant influenza virus having PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and HA viral segments, wherein at least one of the viral segments is a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced genetic stability or enhanced replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue at position 180 in PA that is glutamine, a residue at position 200 in PA that is threonine, a residue at position 149 in PB1 that is valine, a residue at position 684 in PB1 that is glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 in PB1 that is aspartic acid. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, D, E, Q, or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, N, S, H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, E, N, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, C, S. M, F, P, G, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, S, H, T, Y. C, K, R, or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K, S, T, Y, C, or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, H, D, S. H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, K, H, R, Q, or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, N, S. H, T, Y, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G, S, M, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, S, M, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, H, L, R or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the PA further comprises a residue at position 443 that is not arginine, the PB1 further comprises a residue at position 737 that is not lysine, the PB2 further comprises a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, the NS viral segment encodes a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline, the HA viral segment encodes a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the residue at position 443 of PA is K or H, the residue at position 737 of PB1 is H or R, the residue at position 25 of PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, the residue at position 167 of NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is in the NS viral segment, M viral segment, NP viral segment, PA viral segment, PB1 viral segment, or the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the recombinant virus comprises a further viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product. In one embodiment, the further viral segment is a NS viral segment, a M viral segment, a NP viral segment, a PA viral segment, a PB1 viral segment or a PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the virus has a HA that is H1, H2, H3, H5, H7, H9, or H10. In one embodiment, the virus is an influenza B virus.
  • Also provided is an isolated recombinant influenza virus having PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and HA viral segments, wherein at least one of the viral segments is a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, and wherein at least one of the other viral segments is a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced genetic stability or replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue in PB2 at position 712 that is glutamic acid, a residue at position 180 in PA that is glutamine, a residue at position 200 in PA that is threonine, a residue at position 149 in PB1 that is valine, a residue at position 684 in PB1 that is glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 in PB1 that is aspartic acid. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, D, E, Q, or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, N, S, H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, E, N, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, G, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, S, H, T, Y, C, K, R, or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K, S, T, Y, C, or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, H, D, S, H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, K, H, R, Q, or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, N, S, H, T, Y, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G, S, M, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, S, M, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, H, L, R or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the PA further comprises a residue at position 443 that is not arginine, the PB1 further comprises a residue at position 737 that is not lysine, the PB2 further comprises a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, the NS viral segment encodes a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline, the HA viral segment encodes a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the residue at position 443 of PA is K or H, the residue at position 737 of PB1 is H or R, the residue at position 25 of PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, the residue at position 167 of NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is in the NS viral segment, M viral segment, NP viral segment, PA viral segment, PB1 viral segment, or the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the recombinant virus comprises a further viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product. In one embodiment, the further viral segment is a NS viral segment, a M viral segment, a NP viral segment, a PA viral segment, a PB1 viral segment or a PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the virus has a HA that is H1, H2, H3, H5, H7, H9, or H10. In one embodiment, the virus is an influenza B virus.
  • Further provided is an isolated recombinant influenza virus having PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and HA viral segments, wherein the recombinant virus has two or more viral segments comprising a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced genetic stability or replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue in PB2 at position 712 that is glutamic acid, a residue at position 180 in PA that is glutamine, a residue at position 200 in PA that is threonine, a residue at position 149 in PB1 that is valine, a residue at position 684 in PB1 that is glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 in PB1 that is aspartic acid. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, D, E, Q, or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, N, S, H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, E, N, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, G, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, S, H, T, Y, C, K, R, or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K, S, T, Y, C, or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, H, D, S, H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, K, H, R, Q, or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, N, S, H, T, Y, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G, S, M, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, S, M, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, H, L, R or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K or Q. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, the PA further comprises a residue at position 443 that is not arginine, the PB1 further comprises a residue at position 737 that is not lysine, the PB2 further comprises a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, the NS viral segment encodes a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline, the HA viral segment encodes a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the residue at position 443 of PA is K or H, the residue at position 737 of PB1 is H or R, the residue at position 25 of PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, the residue at position 167 of NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is in the NS viral segment, M viral segment, NP viral segment, PA viral segment, PB1 viral segment, or the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment. In one embodiment, the recombinant virus comprises a further viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product. In one embodiment, the further viral segment is a NS viral segment, a M viral segment, a NP viral segment, a PA viral segment, a PB1 viral segment or a PB2 viral segment. In one embodiment, the virus has a HA that is H1, H2, H3, H5, H7, H9, or H10. In one embodiment, the virus is an influenza B virus.
  • The disclosure also provides a vaccine having the isolated recombinant virus.
  • The disclosure provides a plurality of influenza virus vectors for preparing a reassortant, comprising a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB1 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB2 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus HA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NP DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus M DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, and a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NS cDNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, wherein the PB1, PB2, or PA DNAs in the vectors for vRNA production encode at least one of: a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or a combination thereof; and optionally a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB2, and a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NP, and optionally a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus HA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M2, or a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NS2. In one embodiment, the PB1, PB2, PA, NP, NS, and M DNAs in the vectors for vRNA production have a sequence corresponding to one that encodes a polypeptide having at least 95% amino acid sequence identity to a corresponding polypeptide encoded by SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q. In one embodiment, at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product. In one embodiment, the vectors comprise a further vector having a viral segment comprising a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
  • A method to prepare influenza virus is provided, comprising: contacting a cell with a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB1 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB2 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus HA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NP DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus M DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, and a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NS DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, wherein the PB1, PB2, or PA DNAs in the vectors for vRNA production encode i) a PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, and at least one: a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, ii) a PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, or iii) two or more of: a PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof; and optionally a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB2, and a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NP, and optionally a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus HA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M2, or a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NS2; in an amount effective to yield infectious influenza virus. In one embodiment, the cell is an avian cell or a mammalian cell. In one embodiment, the cell is a Vero cell, a human cell or a MDCK cell. In one embodiment, the wherein the PB1, PB2, PA, NP, NS, and M DNAs in the vectors for vRNA productions have a sequence that corresponds to one that encodes a polypeptide having at least 95% amino acid sequence identity to a corresponding polypeptide encoded by SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15. In one embodiment, the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
  • The heterologous sequence, e.g., for a therapeutic or prophylactic gene of interest, which may be in an additional influenza segment, e.g., in one of the segments of a 9 segment influenza A or B virus, in one of 8 viral segments, or in one of the segments in a 7 segment virus, may be an immunogen for a cancer associated antigen or for a pathogen such as a bacteria, a noninfluenza virus, fungus. In one embodiment, the influenza viruses of the disclosure may be vaccine vectors for influenza virus and for at least one other pathogen, such as a viral or bacterial pathogen, or for a pathogen other than influenza virus, pathogens including but not limited to, lentiviruses such as HIV, hepatitis B virus, hepatitis C virus, herpes viruses such as CMV or HSV, Foot and Mouth Disease Virus, Measles virus, Rubella virus, Mumps virus, human Rhinovirus, Parainfluenza viruses, such as respiratory syncytial virus and human parainfluenza virus type 1, Coronavirus, Nipah virus, Hantavirus, Japanese encephalitis virus, Rotavirus, Dengue virus, West Nile virus, Streptococcus pneumoniae, Mycobacterium tuberculosis, Bordetella pertussis, or Haemophilus influenza. For example, the biologically contained influenza virus of the disclosure may include sequences for H protein of Measles virus, viral envelope protein E1 of Rubella virus, HN protein of Mumps virus, RV capsid protein VP1 of human Rhinovirus, G protein of Respiratory syncytial virus, S protein of Coronavirus, G or F protein of Nipah virus, G protein of Hantavirus, E protein of Japanese encephalitis virus, VP6 of Rotavirus, E protein of Dengue virus, E protein of West Nile virus, PspA of Streptococcus pneumonia, HSP65 from Mycobacterium tuberculosis, IRP1-3 of Bordetella pertussis, or the heme utilization protein, protective surface antigen D15, heme binding protein A, or outer membrane protein P1, P2, P5 or P6 of Haemophilus influenza. The gene therapy vector may include a heterologous sequence useful to inhibit or treat, e.g., cancer, AIDS, adenosine deaminase, muscular dystrophy, ornithine transcarbamylase deficiency and central nervous system tumors, or pathogens, or may encode an antibody or fragment thereof, e.g., scFv or a single chain antibody.
  • Pharmaceutical Compositions
  • Pharmaceutical compositions of the present disclosure, suitable for inoculation, e.g., nasal, parenteral or oral administration, comprise one or more influenza virus isolates, e.g., one or more attenuated or inactivated influenza viruses, a subunit thereof, isolated protein(s) thereof, and/or isolated nucleic acid encoding one or more proteins thereof, optionally further comprising sterile aqueous or non-aqueous solutions, suspensions, and emulsions. The compositions can further comprise auxiliary agents or excipients, as known in the art. The composition of the disclosure is generally presented in the form of individual doses (unit doses).
  • Conventional vaccines generally contain about 0.1 to 200 μg, e.g., 30 to 100 μg, 0.1 to 2 μg, 0.5 to 5 μg, 1 to 10 μg, 10 μg to 20 μg, 15 μg to 30 μg, or 10 to 30 μg, of HA from each of the strains entering into their composition. The vaccine forming the main constituent of the vaccine composition of the disclosure may comprise a single influenza virus, or a combination of influenza viruses, for example, at least two or three influenza viruses, including one or more reassortant(s).
  • Preparations for parenteral administration include sterile aqueous or non-aqueous solutions, suspensions, and/or emulsions, which may contain auxiliary agents or excipients known in the art. Examples of non-aqueous solvents are propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, vegetable oils such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters such as ethyl oleate. Carriers or occlusive dressings can be used to increase skin permeability and enhance antigen absorption. Liquid dosage forms for oral administration may generally comprise a liposome solution containing the liquid dosage form. Suitable forms for suspending liposomes include emulsions, suspensions, solutions, syrups, and elixirs containing inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as purified water. Besides the inert diluents, such compositions can also include adjuvants, wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, or sweetening, flavoring, or perfuming agents.
  • When a composition of the present disclosure is used for administration to an individual, it can further comprise salts, buffers, adjuvants, or other substances which are desirable for improving the efficacy of the composition. For vaccines, adjuvants, substances which can augment a specific immune response, can be used. Normally, the adjuvant and the composition are mixed prior to presentation to the immune system, or presented separately, but into the same site of the organism being immunized.
  • Heterogeneity in a vaccine may be provided by mixing replicated influenza viruses for at least two influenza virus strains, such as 2-20 strains or any range or value therein. Vaccines can be provided for variations in a single strain of an influenza virus, using techniques known in the art.
  • A pharmaceutical composition according to the present disclosure may further or additionally comprise at least one chemotherapeutic compound, for example, for gene therapy, immunosuppressants, anti-inflammatory agents or immune enhancers, and for vaccines, chemotherapeutics including, but not limited to, gamma globulin, amantadine, guanidine, hydroxybenzimidazole, interferon-α, interferon-β, interferon-γ, tumor necrosis factor-alpha, thiosemicarbarzones, methisazone, rifampin, ribavirin, a pyrimidine analog, a purine analog, foscarnet, phosphonoacetic acid, acyclovir, dideoxynucleosides, a protease inhibitor, or ganciclovir.
  • The composition can also contain variable but small quantities of endotoxin-free formaldehyde, and preservatives, which have been found safe and not contributing to undesirable effects in the organism to which the composition is administered.
  • Pharmaceutical Purposes
  • The administration of the composition (or the antisera that it elicits) may be for either a “prophylactic” or “therapeutic” purpose. When provided prophylactically, the compositions of the disclosure which are vaccines are provided before any symptom or clinical sign of a pathogen infection becomes manifest. The prophylactic administration of the composition serves to prevent or attenuate any subsequent infection. When provided prophylactically, the gene therapy compositions of the disclosure, are provided before any symptom or clinical sign of a disease becomes manifest. The prophylactic administration of the composition serves to prevent or attenuate one or more symptoms or clinical signs associated with the disease.
  • When provided therapeutically, a viral vaccine is provided upon the detection of a symptom or clinical sign of actual infection. The therapeutic administration of the compound(s) serves to attenuate any actual infection. When provided therapeutically, a gene therapy composition is provided upon the detection of a symptom or clinical sign of the disease. The therapeutic administration of the compound(s) serves to attenuate a symptom or clinical sign of that disease.
  • Thus, a vaccine composition of the present disclosure may be provided either before the onset of infection (so as to prevent or attenuate an anticipated infection) or after the initiation of an actual infection. Similarly, for gene therapy, the composition may be provided before any symptom or clinical sign of a disorder or disease is manifested or after one or more symptoms are detected.
  • A composition is said to be “pharmacologically acceptable” if its administration can be tolerated by a recipient mammal. Such an agent is said to be administered in a “therapeutically effective amount” if the amount administered is physiologically significant. A composition of the present disclosure is physiologically significant if its presence results in a detectable change in the physiology of a recipient patient, e.g., enhances at least one primary or secondary humoral or cellular immune response against at least one strain of an infectious influenza virus.
  • The “protection” provided need not be absolute, i.e., the influenza infection need not be totally prevented or eradicated, if there is a statistically significant improvement compared with a control population or set of mammals. Protection may be limited to mitigating the severity or rapidity of onset of symptoms or clinical signs of the influenza virus infection.
  • Pharmaceutical Administration
  • A composition of the present disclosure may confer resistance to one or more pathogens, e.g., one or more influenza virus strains, by either passive immunization or active immunization. In active immunization, an attenuated live vaccine composition is administered prophylactically to a host (e.g., a mammal), and the host's immune response to the administration protects against infection and/or disease. For passive immunization, the elicited antisera can be recovered and administered to a recipient suspected of having an infection caused by at least one influenza virus strain. A gene therapy composition of the present disclosure may yield prophylactic or therapeutic levels of the desired gene product by active immunization.
  • In one embodiment, the vaccine is provided to a mammalian female (at or prior to pregnancy or parturition), under conditions of time and amount sufficient to cause the production of an immune response which serves to protect both the female and the fetus or newborn (via passive incorporation of the antibodies across the placenta or in the mother's milk).
  • The present disclosure thus includes methods for preventing or attenuating a disorder or disease, e.g., an infection by at least one strain of pathogen. As used herein, a vaccine is said to prevent or attenuate a disease if its administration results either in the total or partial attenuation (i.e., suppression) of a clinical sign or condition of the disease, or in the total or partial immunity of the individual to the disease. As used herein, a gene therapy composition is said to prevent or attenuate a disease if its administration results either in the total or partial attenuation (i.e., suppression) of a clinical sign or condition of the disease, or in the total or partial immunity of the individual to the disease.
  • A composition having at least one influenza virus of the present disclosure, including one which is attenuated and one or more other isolated viruses, one or more isolated viral proteins thereof, one or more isolated nucleic acid molecules encoding one or more viral proteins thereof, or a combination thereof, may be administered by any means that achieve the intended purposes.
  • For example, administration of such a composition may be by various parenteral routes such as subcutaneous, intravenous, intradermal, intramuscular, intraperitoneal, intranasal, oral or transdermal routes.
  • Parenteral administration can be accomplished by bolus injection or by gradual perfusion over time.
  • A typical regimen for preventing, suppressing, or treating an influenza virus related pathology, comprises administration of an effective amount of a vaccine composition as described herein, administered as a single treatment, or repeated as enhancing or booster dosages, over a period up to and including between one week and about 24 months, or any range or value therein.
  • According to the present disclosure, an “effective amount” of a composition is one that is sufficient to achieve a desired effect. It is understood that the effective dosage may be dependent upon the species, age, sex, health, and weight of the recipient, kind of concurrent treatment, if any, frequency of treatment, and the nature of the effect wanted. The ranges of effective doses provided below are not intended to limit the invention and represent dose ranges.
  • The dosage of a live, attenuated or killed virus vaccine for an animal such as a mammalian adult organism may be from about 102-1020, e.g., 103-1012, 102-1010, 105-1011, 106-1015, 102-1010, or 1015-1020 plaque forming units (PFU)/kg, or any range or value therein. The dose of one viral isolate vaccine, e.g., in an inactivated vaccine, may range from about 0.1 to 1000, e.g., 0.1 to 10 μg, 1 to 20 μg, 30 to 100 μg, 10 to 50 μg, 50 to 200 μg, or 150 to 300 μg, of HA protein. However, the dosage should be a safe and effective amount as determined by conventional methods, using existing vaccines as a starting point.
  • The dosage of immunoreactive HA in each dose of replicated virus vaccine may be standardized to contain a suitable amount, e.g., 0.1 μg to 1 μg, 0.5 μg to 5 μg, 1 μg to 10 μg, 10 μg to 20 μg, 15 μg to 30 μg, or 30 μg to 100 μg or any range or value therein, or the amount recommended by government agencies or recognized professional organizations. The quantity of NA can also be standardized, however, this glycoprotein may be labile during purification and storage.
  • The dosage of immunoreactive HA in each dose of replicated virus vaccine can be standardized to contain a suitable amount, e.g., 1-50 μg or any range or value therein, or the amount recommended by the U.S. Public Health Service (PHS), which is usually 15 μg, per component for older children >3 years of age, and 7.5 μg per component for children <3 years of age. The quantity of NA can also be standardized, however, this glycoprotein can be labile during the processor purification and storage (Kendal et al., 1980; Kerr et al., 1975). Each 0.5-ml dose of vaccine may contain approximately 0.1 to 0.5 billion viral particles, 0.5 to 2 billion viral particles, 1 to 50 billion virus particles, 1 to 10 billion viral particles, 20 to 40 billion viral particles, 1 to 5 billion viral particles, or 40 to 80 billion viral particles.
  • The invention will be further described by the following non-limiting examples.
  • Example I Methods Generation of Color-Flu
  • The NS segments of PR8 fused with different fluorescent reporter genes including eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry were constructed by overlapping fusion PCR as described in Manicassamy et al. (2010). In brief, the open reading frame (ORF) of the NS1 gene without the stop codon was fused with the N-terminus of fluorescent reporter genes via a sequence encoding the amino acid linker GSGG. The fluorescent reporter ORFs were followed by a sequence encoding the GSG linker, a foot-and-mouth virus protease 2A autoproteolytic site with 57 nucleotides from porcine teschovirus-1 in Manicassamy et al. (2010), and by the ORF of nuclear export protein (NEP) (FIG. 5). In addition, silent mutations were introduced into the endogenous splice acceptor site of the NS1 gene to abrogate splicing (Basler et al., 2001). The constructed NS segments (designated eCFP-NS, eGFP-NS, Venus-NS, and mCherry-NS) were subsequently cloned into a pPoll vector for reverse genetics as described in Newmann et al. (1999). The plasmid encoding the Venus reporter protein was a kind gift from Dr. A. Miyawaki (Laboratory for Cell Function Dynamics, RIKEN Brain Science Institute, Wako, Japan) (Nagai et al., 2002). WT−Venus−PR8 was generated by using the reverse genetics system as described in Newmann et al. (1999). Since WT−Venus−PR8 pathogenicity and Venus expression levels were appreciably attenuated in mice, WT−Venus−PR8 was serially passaged in mice. After six passages, a variant (MA−Venus−PR8) was obtained with increased pathogenicity and strong Venus expression. A stock of MA−Venus−PR8 was generated in MDCK cells. Since serial passage in animals typically results in virus populations composed of genetic variants, MA−Venus−PR8 was recreated by using reverse genetics. Likewise, MA−eCFP-PR8, −eGFP-PR8, and −mCherry-PR8 were generated with the same genetic backbone as MA−Venus−PR8.
  • To generate a Venus−HPAI virus by reverse genetics, the NS segment of A/Vietnam/1203/2004 (H5N1; VN1203) was replaced with Venus-NS of PR8, and the virus was adapted to mice as described for MA−Venus−PR8. A stock of MA−Venus−HPAI virus was made in MDCK cells. The set of these influenza viruses carrying various fluorescent proteins was collectively termed “Color-flu”.
  • Mouse Experiments
  • Female, 6-week-old C57BLU6 (‘B6’) mice were purchased from Japan SLC, Inc. (Shizuoka, Japan). Mice were intranasally inoculated with Color-flu viruses, at the dosages indicated in the figure panels, in 50 μL of PBS under sevoflurane anesthesia, and body weights and survival were monitored for 14 days. Lungs were harvested from PBS-inoculated or Color-flu-infected mice for virus titration, flow cytometric analysis, and histological experiments at the times indicated in the figure panels. All animal experiments were performed in accordance with the regulations of the University of Tokyo Committee for Animal Care and Use and were approved by the Animal Experiment Committee of the Institute of Medical Science of the University of Tokyo.
  • Histology and Cytology
  • Lungs were fixed in 4% paraformaldehyde (PFA) phosphate buffer solution. Fixed tissues were embedded in OCT compound (Sakura Finetek, Tokyo, Japan), frozen by liquid N2 and stored at −80° C. Cryostat 6-μm sections were treated for 30 minutes with PBS containing 1% BSA (PBS-BSA) to block nonspecific binding, and then incubated with phycoerythrin (PE)-Mac3 (M3/84, BD Biosciences. San Jose, Calif.). To examine the cytology of the MDCK cells, cells were infected with Color-flu virus and then fixed in 4% PFA phosphate buffer solution. Nuclei were stained with Hoechst33342 (Invitrogen, Carlsbad, Calif.). Sections and cells were visualized by using a confocal microscope (Nikon A1, Nikon, Tokyo, Japan), controlled by NIS-Elements software. For quantitative multi-color imaging analysis, the slides were visualized by use of an inverted fluorescence microscope (Nikon Eclipse TS100) with a Nuance FX multispectral imaging system with InForm software (PerkinElmer, Waltham, Mass.).
  • Whole-Mount Imaging of Lung Tissue
  • Mice were euthanized and intracardially perfused with PBS to remove blood cells from the lung. The lungs were isolated after intratracheal perfusion with 4% PFA phosphate buffer solution. The lung tissues were cleared with SCALEVIEW-A2 solution (Olympus, Tokyo, Japan) according to the manufacturer's instructions. Images were acquired by using a stereo fluorescence microscope (M205FA, Leica Microsystems, Wetzlar, Germany) equipped with a digital camera (DFC365FX, Leica Microsystems).
  • Two-Photon Laser Microscopy
  • A total of 105 PFU of MA−eGFP−PR8 was intranasally inoculated into B6 mice. To label lung macrophages, 50 μL of PE−CD11b (M1/70, BioLegend, San Diego, Calif.) was injected intravenously to the mice at day 3 p.i. Thirty minutes after the antibody injection, the lungs of the mice were harvested. The kinetics of eGFP- and PE-positive cells in the lungs were imaged with a multi-photon microscope (LSM 710 NLO, Carl Zeiss, Oberkochen, Germany). During the analysis, the lungs were maintained in complete medium (RPMI 1640 with 10% fetal calf serum) in a humid chamber (37° C., 5% CO2). The data were processed with LSM software Zen 2009 (Carl Zeiss). For three-dimensional imaging of HPAI virus-infected lung tissues, B6 mice were intranasally inoculated with 105 PFU of MA−Venus−HPAI virus. The lung tissues were collected from the mice at day 2 p.i., and treated with SCALEVIEW-A2 solution (Olympus) to make tissues transparent as described above. Three-dimensional images of lung tissues were obtained from a multi-photon microscope (Nikon A1R MP).
  • Flow Cytometric Analysis and Cell Sorting
  • To obtain single-cell suspensions, lungs were dissociated with Collagenase D (Roche Diagnostics, Mannheim, Germany; final concentration: 2 g/mL) and DNase I (Worthington Biochemical, Lakewood, N.J.; final concentration: 40 U/mL) for 30 minutes at 37° C. by grinding the tissue through nylon filters (BD Biosciences). Red blood cells (RBCs) were lysed by treatment with RBC lysing buffer (Sigma Aldrich, St. Louis, Mo.). To block nonspecific binding of antibodies, cells were incubated with purified anti-mouse CD16/32 (Fc Block, BD Biosciences, San Diego, Calif.). Cells were stained with appropriate combinations of fluorescent antibodies to analyze the population of each immune cell subset. The following antibodies were used: anti-CD45 (30-F11: eBioscience, San Diego, Calif.), anti-CD11b (M1/70: BioLegend), anti-F4180 (BM8: eBioscience), and anti-CD11c (HL3: BD Biosciences). All samples were also incubated with 7-aminoactinomycin D (Via-Probe, BD Biosciences) for dead cell exclusion. Data from labeled cells were acquired on a FACSAria II (BD Biosciences) and analyzed with FlowJo software version 9.3.1 (Tree Star, San Carlos, Calif.). To isolate Venus-positive and -negative macrophages from lungs, stained cells were sorted using a FACSAria II (BD Biosciences).
  • Microarray Analysis
  • Total RNA of sorted macrophages was extracted using TRIzol reagent (Life Technologies, Carlsbad, Calif.) and precipitated with isopropanol. RNA amplification was performed using the Arcturus Riboamp Plus RNA Amplification Kit (Life technologies) in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. RNA was labeled by using the Agilent Low Input Quick Amp Labeling kit, one color (Agilent Technologies, Santa Clara, Calif.) and hybridized to the SurePrint G3 Mouse GE 8X60K microarray (Agilent Technologies). Arrays were scanned with a DNA Microarray Scanner with SureScan High-Resolution Technology, (G2565CA; Agilent Technologies), and data were acquired using Agilent Feature Extraction software ver. 10.7.3.1. (Agilent Technologies). Probe annotations were provided by Agilent Technologies (AMADID 028005). Probe intensities were background corrected and normalized using the normal-exponential and quantile methods, respectively. The log2 of the intensities were then fit to a linear model that compared the groups of interest34. All reported p values were adjusted for multiple hypothesis comparisons using the Benjamini-Hochberg method. Transcripts were considered differentially expressed if there was at least a 2-fold change in the mean probe intensity between contrasts with an adjusted p<0.01. Hierarchical clustering was performed in R. The resultant gene clusters were then analyzed with ToppCluster (Kaimal et al., 2010) to identify gene annotations that were enriched in each cluster. The reported scores are the −log10 of the Benjamini-Hochberg adjusted p-value.
  • Western Blot Analysis
  • Whole lysates of MDCK cells were electrophoresed through SDS-polyacrylamide gels (Bio-Rad Laboratories, Hercules, Calif.) and transferred to a PVDF membrane (Millipore, Billerica, Mass.). The membrane was blocked with Blocking One (Nacalai Tesque, Kyoto, Japan) and incubated with a rabbit anti-GFP polyclonal antibody (MBL, Nagoya, Japan), mouse anti-NS1 antibody (188/5), rabbit antiserum to A/WSN/33(H1N1)(R309) or mouse anti-actin antibody (A2228; Sigma-Aldrich), followed by HR-conjugated anti-mouse or anti-rabbit IgG antibody (GE Healthcare, Waukesha, Wis.). After the membrane was washed with PBS-Tween, specific proteins were detected using ECL Plus Western Blotting Detection System (GE Healthcare. The specific protein bands were visualized by the use of the VersaDoc Imaging System (Bio-Rad).
  • Results
  • To generate a fluorescent influenza virus expressing a reporter protein fused to the NS1 open reading frame, Venus was chosen, a GFP variant with eight mutations including F46L, which improves chromophore formation and increases brightness compared with GFP (Wagai et al., 2002). As expected based on previous findings of attenuation for influenza viruses expressing reporter proteins (Kittel et al., 2004; Shinhya et al., 2004), the mouse pathogenicity of A/Puerto Rico/8/34 (PR8; H1N1) virus expressing Venus (WT−Venus−PR8) was substantially lower than that of wild-type PR8 (WT−PR8); the dose required to kill 50% of infected mice (MLD50) was more than 104.5 plaque-forming units (PFU) for WT−Venus−PR8 compared with 102.5 PFU for WT-PR8. WT−Venus−PR8 was serially passaged in C57BL/6 (B6) mice. After six consecutive passages, a variant (designated MA−Venus−PR8; possessing a T-to-A mutation at position 380 of the hemagglutinin protein, and an E-to-D mutation at position 712 of the polymerase subunit PB2) was identified with appreciably higher pathogenicity (MLD50=103.5 PFU) compared with WT−Venus−PR8, although it was still less pathogenic than the original PR8 virus (FIG. 1A). To assess the replicative ability of MA−Venus−PR8 in mouse lungs, B6 mice were intranasally infected with 104 PFU of MA−Venus−PR8 or PR8 virus. At all time points tested, the lung virus titers were similar for MA−Venus−PR8- and PR8-infected mice (FIG. 1B). To test the stability of Venus expression, plaque assays were performed using lung homogenate from infected mice and found that only one of 150 plaques on each of days 3, 5, and 7 post-infection (p.i.) was Venus-negative, attesting to the high genetic stability of Venus expression in this recombinant virus. In contrast, only 70% of NS1-GFP virus expressed the reporter protein (Manicassamy et al., 2010). The robust virulence and genetic stability of MA−Venus−PR8 indicate that this virus represents a highly attractive reporter system to visualize influenza virus-infected cells in vivo.
  • TABLE 1
    Replication and virulence of Color-flu in mice*.
    Mean virus titer (log10 PFU/g ± s.d.) in
    the mouse lung on the indicated day p.i.
    Virus Day 3 p.i. Day 5 p.i. Day 7 p.i. MLD50 (PFU)
    MA-eCFP-PR8  8.1 ± 0.2** 8.0 ± 0.1 6.3 ± 0.1 103.0
    MA-eGFP-PR8 8.6 ± 0.1 8.3 ± 0.1 6.3 ± 0.1 103.5
    MA-Venus-PR8 8.6 ± 0.2 8.4 ± 0.1 6.5 ± 0.3 103.3
    MA-mCherry-PR8  7.7 ± 0.3** 7.5 ± 0.7 6.1 ± 0.4 102.7
    WT-Venus-PR8  5.6 ± 0.3**  5.3 ± 0.3**  5.2 ± 0.2** >104.3
    WT-PR8 8.8 ± 0.1 8.2 ± 0.5 6.9 ± 0.2 102.5
    MA-PR8 8.9 ± 0.1 9.0 ± 0.0  7.9 ± 0.2** 102.3
    *B6 mice were inoculated intranasally with 104 PFU of each virus in a 50 mL volume. Three mice from each group were killed on days 3, 5 and 7 p.i., and virus titres in the lungs were determined in MDCK cells.
    **Statistical significance was calculated by using the Student's t-test; the P value was <0.01 compared with the titres in the lungs of mice infected with WT-PR8 virus.
  • To increase the versatility of fluorescent influenza viruses as imaging tools, additional MA−PR8 variants were generated that expressed different spectral GFP mutants, namely, eCFP (ex. 434 nm, em. 477 nm) and eGFP (ex. 489 nm, em. 508 nm) (Patterson, 2001). A mCherry variant (ex. 587 nm, em. 610 nm), which emits fluorescence at a longer wavelength than Venus (ex. 515 nm, em. 528 nm) (Nagai et al., 2002; Shaner et al., 2004), was also generated. These influenza viruses encoding the multi-spectral fluorescent reporter proteins were collectively named “Color-flu”. To determine the pathogenicity of Color-flu viruses, the virus titres in mouse lung tissues and the MLD50 values of MA−eCFP, eGFP and mCherry-PR8 were compared with those of MA−Venus−PR8 and MA−PR8. All of virus strains showed comparatively high replication in the lungs and the MLD50 values were similar among the Color-flu viruses (Table 1). The stability of the fluorescent expression of the Color-flu viruses was tested in vivo and in vitro by plaque assay. When virus was collected from the lungs of mice on day 7 p.i., the percentages of fluorescent-positive plaques were 98.0% (MA−eCFP-PR8), 100.0% (MA−eGFP−PR8) and 96.4% (MA−mCherry−PR8). The percentages of fluorescent-positive plaques in the sample from the culture medium of MDCK cells after 72 hours p.i. was found to be 100.0% (MA−eCFP-PR8), 99.2% (MA−eGFP−PR8) and 98.2% (MA−mCherry−PR8). In addition, the stability of an NS1-fluorescent protein chimera in virus-infected cells was examined by infecting MDCK cells with MA−Venus−PR8 virus and detecting NS1−Venus chimeric protein by using anti-GFP and anti-NS1 antibodies. The NS1−Venus chimeric protein was not degraded until the time point examined (that is, 12 hours p.i.), indicating that the fluorescent signal is mainly emitted from the NS1-fluorescent protein chimera and not from degradation products in cells infected with Color-flu viruses. These findings indicate that the pathogenicity and stability of the Color-flu viruses were not affected by the different fluorescent reporter genes.
  • To assess the expression of Color-flu viruses in mouse lungs, we collected lungs from B6 mice infected with each of the Color-flu viruses and processed them for visualization as described in the Methods section. All four colors were clearly visible in whole transparent lung tissue when analyzed with a fluorescent stereomicroscope (FIG. 2A). Fluorescent signals were mainly seen in the bronchial epithelial layer at day 3 p.i. At day 5 p.i., fluorescent signals extended to the peripheral alveolar regions. These data indicated that all four Color-flu viruses are useful for analyzing the distribution of influenza virus-infected cells in mouse lungs. To assess the expression of Color-flu viruses in mouse lungs, lungs were collected from B6 mice infected with each of the Color-flu viruses and processed them for visualization as described in the Methods section. All four colors were clearly visible in whole transparent lung tissue when analyzed with a fluorescent stereomicroscope (FIG. 2A). Fluorescent signals were mainly seen in the bronchial epithelial layer at day 3 p.i. At day 5 p.i., fluorescent signals extended to the peripheral alveolar regions. These data indicate that all four Color-flu viruses are useful for analyzing the distribution of influenza virus-infected cells in mouse lungs.
  • Next, the Nuance™ spectral imaging system was employed to test whether the fluorescent signals of all four Color-flu viruses could be detected simultaneously. Lung tissues were collected from B6 mice intranasally inoculated with a mixture of the four strains (2.5×104 PFU each in a total volume of 50 μL). Analysis of lung sections obtained at days 2 and 5 p.i. showed that the fluorescent signals of all four Color-flu viruses were distinguishable from each other (FIG. 2B). At day 2 p.i., clusters of the same fluorescent color were found in bronchial epithelial cells, suggesting local spread of the individual viruses. At this time point, a limited number of alveolar cells were infected. At day 5 p.i., we detected a cluster of alveolar cells expressing a single fluorescent protein, indicative of the initiation of infection with a single virus and its local spread (FIG. 2B). Interestingly, epithelial cells simultaneously expressing two or three fluorescent proteins were detected, albeit at a low frequency, suggesting co-infection of these cells (FIG. 2C). The ability to visualize cells co-infected with different influenza viruses in vivo is a major advance in technology and will allow insights into influenza co-infection and reassortment processes.
  • Next, the utility of Color-flu viruses was tested for the analysis of host responses to infection. Since macrophages are involved in innate immunity and acute inflammation in influenza virus-infected lungs, lung sections that were stained with an antibody to macrophages (PE-Mac3) were examined by using confocal microscopy. Macrophages infiltrated regions containing Venus-positive bronchial epithelial cells at day 2 p.i. of mice with MA−Venus−PR8 (FIG. 3A); by contrast, only a few Mac3-positive cells were detected in the alveoli of lungs from mock-infected animals. On the basis of this finding, live imaging was employed to further study the interaction between influenza virus-infected epithelial cells and macrophages in mouse lungs. In the lung tissue of naive B6 mice, CD11b+ alveolar macrophages were detected by use of a two-photon laser microscope. Most of these macrophages did not migrate (i.e., showed little movement) during the observation period (49 minutes; data not shown). In mice infected with MA−eGFP−PR8 virus, many CD11b+ macrophages appeared to be ‘attached’ to eGFP-positive epithelial cells (data not shown); moreover, some of these eGFP-positive epithelial cells exhibited blebbing similar to apoptotic cells. Interestingly, a number of CD11b+ macrophages quickly moved around the eGFP-positive epithelial cells, suggesting possible macrophage responses to inflammatory signals such as IFNs or chemokines. The present system can thus be used to monitor the in vivo interactions between virus-infected and immune cells.
  • A number of studies have assessed the transcriptomics and proteomics profiles of influenza virus-infected mice (Go et al., 2012; Zhao et al., 2012). Since these studies used whole lung samples, the results are the sum of virus-infected and uninfected cells, leading to the dilution of host responses and not allowing one to distinguish the profiles of infected cells from those of uninfected, bystander cells. As a first step to overcome this shortcoming, macrophages (known to be infected by influenza viruses (FIG. 3B)) from the lungs of mice infected with MA−Venus−PR8 were sorted on the basis of their fluorescent protein expression and performed microarray analysis. Macrophages isolated from the lungs of mice inoculated with PBS (naive macrophages) served as controls. In fluorescent-positive macrophages, 6,199 transcripts were differently expressed relative to naive macrophages. By contrast, in fluorescent-negative macrophages obtained from infected mice, only 4,252 transcripts were differentially expressed relative to the naive macrophages. This difference likely reflects differences in gene transcription induced by active influenza virus infection. However, it should be noted that the fluorescent-negative cell populations obtained from infected animals may have included infected cells in which the fluorescent signal had not yet been detected as would be expected at an early stage of virus infection. In fact, confocal microscopy revealed that it took 9 hours to detect fluorescent protein expression in the majority of MDCK cells. Hierarchical clustering of differentially expressed transcripts, followed by functional enrichment analysis of each cluster, indicated that both fluorescent-positive and fluorescent-negative macrophages obtained from infected animals exhibit activation of pathways associated with the immune response, cytokine production, and inflammation (FIG. 3D, green cluster). The upregulation of these pathways in the fluorescent-negative cells may have resulted from cell activation by IFN and cytokines released from infected cells, and/or from cells that were at an early stage of virus infection (as discussed earlier). Yet, a subset of enriched annotations, for example, type I IFN-mediated signaling (FIG. 3D, light blue cluster), included transcripts that were more highly expressed in fluorescent-positive macrophages. In addition, it was observed that type I IFN genes were among the most upregulated transcripts in the fluorescent-positive macrophages (FIG. 3E). Taken together, this enhanced type I IFN activity is consistent with the suggestion that the fluorescent-positive cells had been infected whereas the fluorescent-negative cells included both uninfected (but potentially ‘stimulated’) cells and cells at early stages of influenza virus infection. Indeed, it took at least 5 hours to detect fluorescent protein expression after infection with Color-flu viruses, although all of the fluorescent proteins (that is, eCFP, eGFP, Venus, and mCherry) were detectable in the majority of cells by 9 hours p.i. These findings open new avenues in infectious disease research to compare gene expression (or other types of expression) patterns of reporter protein-positive cells with those of reporter protein-negative cells (but potentially stimulated by released cytokines and/or are at an early stage of infection).
  • Finally, as discussed in more detail in Example II, it was tested whether the concept of mouse-adapted fluorescent influenza viruses could be applied to other influenza virus strains, such as highly pathogenic avian influenza A (H5N1) (HPAI) viruses, which are a research priority due to the threat they pose to humans. An MA−Venus−HPAI virus based on A/Vietnam/1203/2004 (VN1203; H5N1) was generated, employing the same strategy used to create MA−Venus−PR8; however, the PR8 NS gene was used to express NS1−Venus chimeric protein because Venus virus with the VN1203 NS gene did not contribute to pathogenicity in mice. The pathogenicity of MA−Venus−HPAI virus for B6 mice was comparable to that of VN1203, with MLD50 values for both viruses being less than 5 PFU (FIG. 4A and Hatta et al., 2007). MA−Venus−HPAI virus also shared with other HPAI viruses the ability to spread systemically and replicate in various organs including spleen, kidney, and brain (FIG. 4B and Hatta et al., 2007). Moreover, taking advantage of the strong fluorescent signal emitted by MA−Venus−HPAI virus-infected cells, a three-dimensional image of an HPAI virus-infected bronchus deep inside the lung tissues was successfully constructed (FIG. 4C and data not shown). This type of three-dimensional imaging analysis will improve the understanding of the spatial distribution of influenza virus-infected bronchi. When the distribution of virus-infected cells was compared between HPAI virus and PR8-infected lungs, it was found that HPAI virus spreads from the bronchial epithelium to alveolar sites more quickly than did PR8 (FIGS. 4C and D). By using flow cytometric analysis, it was found that CD45-negative, non-hematopoietic cells and F4/80-positive macrophages more frequently expressed Venus in the lungs of mice infected with MA−Venus−HPAI virus than in the lungs of animals inoculated with MA−Venus−PR8 (FIGS. 4E and F), supporting findings that H5N1 HPAI viruses induce more severe inflammatory responses in the lung than does PR8, demonstrating the utility of Color-flu viruses for comparative studies of influenza pathogenesis.
  • Discussion
  • In this study, Color-flu viruses were generated to study influenza virus infections at the cellular level. Color-flu viruses combine several improvements over existing systems, including robust viral replication, virulence, stable fluorescent protein expression, and a set of four different colors that can be visualized simultaneously. Color-flu viruses are applicable to all influenza virus strains. These improvements allowed global transcriptomics analyses of infected and bystander cells and, for the first time, live-imaging of influenza virus-infected cells in the mouse lung.
  • Previous versions of fluorescent influenza viruses (Kittel et al., 2004; Shinya et al., 2004) including our original construct (i.e., WT−Venus−PR8) were appreciably attenuated in mice. These attenuated fluorescent viruses may still be useful for identifying initial target cells. However, the immune responses elicited by these highly attenuated, non-lethal viruses most likely differ considerably from those of the mouse-lethal parent virus, making their use for pathogenesis studies problematic. This problem was solved by passaging viruses in mice. This strategy proved to be successful for two different influenza virus strains, suggesting its broad applicability. A second drawback of previously tested fluorescent influenza viruses is the genetic instability of the added reporter protein (Manicassamy et al., 2010). However, almost 100% of virus plaques examined from mouse lung samples on day 7 post-infection expressed the reporter protein.
  • At present, Color-flu viruses cannot be monitored in live animals non-invasively because fluorescent reporter proteins must be within a “biological optical window (650-900 nm)” to be detected for imaging of tissues in live animals using fluorescent probes (Weisslander, 2001; Jobsis, 1977), and none of the fluorescent reporter proteins including mCherry, which has the longest emission among the reporter proteins of Color-flu, is inside this biological optical window. Heaton et al. (2013) generated a luciferase reporter-expressing influenza virus that can be used to monitor virus replication in live animals; however, this system needs systemic inoculation of substrate into the animals at every observation point. In addition, the resolution of their imaging system (based on the IVIS® system) is not adequate for the analysis of cellular immune mechanisms in vivo, which we are able to achieve with the present system.
  • Newer technologies for imaging analysis (Ghoznari et al., 2013) have enabled the development of a set of four different influenza color variants that can be distinguished from one another by using Nuance™, hence allowing their simultaneous detection. In fact, our pilot study identified lung epithelial cells expressing two or three different fluorescent proteins (FIG. 2C). This may be the first visualization of mouse lung cells infected with more than one influenza virus strain. In future studies, these color variants could be used to address long-standing questions in influenza virus research, such as the frequency of viral co-infections in vivo, which may be critical to better understand influenza virus reassortment and, hence, the generation of novel influenza viruses such as the pandemic viruses of 1957 (Schaltissek et al., 1978; Kanaoka et al., 1989), 1968 (Schaltissek et al., 1978; Kanaoka et al., 1989), and 2009 (Smith et al., 2009; Itoh et al., 2009).
  • By employing the described tool sets, influenza virus-infected cells were detected in whole lung tissues of mice, allowing the observation of the location and distribution of influenza viruses in the lung. Moreover, interactions of virus-infected epithelial cells with immune cells were observed. Such studies will allow direct monitoring influenza disease progression from acute bronchitis to severe viral pneumonia, which causes considerable morbidity and mortality in highly pathogenic influenza virus infections (Gambotto et al., 2008; Shieh et al., 2009).
  • In conclusion, Color-flu viruses in combination with advanced imaging technologies allow for detection at the cellular level in animals.
  • Example II
  • As disclosed in Example I, an H5N1 virus with the Venus (Nagai et al., 2002) (a variant of eGFP) reporter gene (designated wild-type Venus−H5N1 virus, and abbreviated as WT−Venus−H5N1 virus) was prepared using reverse genetics; this virus showed moderate virulence and low Venus expression in mice. After six passages in mice a mouse-adapted Venus−H5N1 virus was acquired (abbreviated as MA−Venus−H5N1 virus) that stably expressed high levels of Venus in vivo and was lethal to mice; a dose required to kill 50% of infected mice (MLD50) was 3.2 plaque-forming units (PFU), while that of its parent WT−Venus−H5N1 virus was 103 PFU. However, the mechanism for this difference in virulence and Venus stability was unclear.
  • In this study, the molecular mechanism that determines the virulence and Venus stability of Venus−H5N1 virus in mice was explored. By using reverse genetics, various reassortants between WT−Venus−H5N1 and MA−Venus−H5N1 virus were rescued and their virulence in mice examined to identify determinants for pathogenicity. Further, the determinants for Venus expression and Venus stability in vitro and in vivo were investigated. The findings further the understanding of the pathogenicity of influenza virus in mammals and will benefit the development of influenza virus-related vaccines and therapy.
  • Materials and Methods
  • Cells. Human embryonic kidney 293 and 293T cells were maintained in Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium (DMEM) with 10% fetal calf serum, and Madin-Darby canine kidney (MDCK) cells were maintained in minimal essential medium (MEM) supplemented with 5% newborn calf serum. All the cells were incubated at 37° C. in 5% CO2.
  • Construction of Plasmids. Plasmids for virus rescue was constructed as described in Neumann et al. (1999). To measure viral polymerase activity, the open reading frames of the PB1, PB2, PA, and NP of influenza virus were amplified by PCR with gene-specific primers and cloned into the pCAGGS/MCS protein expression plasmid (Dias et al., 2009). The primer sequences are listed below:
  • TABLE 2 
    Gene Primer sequence (5′---3′)
    VN1203- Upper CCCATCGATACCATGGAGAGGATAAAAGAATTACG
    P82 AGATC (SEQ ID NO: 20)
    Low CTAGCTAGCCTACTAATTGATGGCCATCCGAATTC
    TTTTG (SEQ ID NO: 21)
    VN1203- Upper TACGAGCTCACCATGGATGTCAATCCGACTTTACT
    PK TTT (SEQ ID NO: 22)
    Low CTAGCTAGCCTACTATTTTTGCCGTCTGAGTTCTT
    CAATG (SEQ ID NO: 23)
    VN1203- Upper CCCATCGATACCATGGAAGACTTTGTGCGACAATG
    PA C (SEQ ID NO: 24)
    Low CTAGCTAGCCTACTATTTCAGTGCATGTGCGAGGA
    AGGA (SEQ ID NO: 25)
    VN1203- Upper TTCATCGATACCATGGCGTCTCAAGGCACCAAAC 
    NP (SEQ ID NO: 26)
    Low CGCGCTAGCCTATTAATTGTCATACTCCTCTGCAT
    TGTCT (SEQ ID NO: 27)

    All of the constructs were completely sequenced to ensure the absence of unwanted mutations.
  • Plasmid-Based Reverse Genetics. Influenza A viruses were generated by using plasmid-based reverse genetics, as described previously (Murakami, 2008; Ozawa et al.; 2007). Viral titers of the rescued viruses were determined by use of plaque assays in MDCK cells. All rescued viruses were sequenced to confirm the absence of unwanted mutations.
  • Mouse Experiments. Six-week-old female C57/BL6 (B6) mice (Japan SLC, Inc., Shizuoka, Japan) were used in this study. To measure viral replication in mice, six mice in each group were anesthetized with isoflurane and then intranasally inoculated with 105 PFU (50 μL) of virus. On days 1 and 3 post-infection (p.i.) three mice were euthanized, and their organs including the lungs, kidneys, spleens, and brains were collected and titrated in MDCK cells. To determine the 50% mouse lethal dose (MLD50) of the viruses, four mice from each group were inoculated intranasally with 10-fold serial dilutions containing 100 to 105 PFU (50 L) of virus, respectively. Body weight and survival were monitored daily for 14 days. The MLD50 was calculated by using the method of Reed and Muench (1938). All mouse experiments were performed in accordance with the University of Tokyo's Regulations for Animal Care and Use and were approved by the Animal Experiment Committee of the Institute of Medical Science, the University of Tokyo.
  • Virus Passage in Mice and MDCK Cells. Mouse adaptation of virus was performed as described in Example I. For virus passages in MDCK cells, confluent MDCK cells were infected with virus at a multiplicity of infection (MOI) of 0.0001. At 48 hours post-infection (hpi) the supernatants were collected and titered in MDCK cells. The new, harvested viruses were used to infect MDCK cells for the next passage. This procedure was repeated five times.
  • Growth Kinetics Assays. Each virus was inoculated into triplicate wells of subconfluent MDCK cells at an MOI of 0.0001. The cells were supplemented with MEM containing 0.3% bovine serum albumin (BSA) and 1 μg/mL tosylsulfonyl phenylalanyl chloromethyl ketone (TPCK) trypsin and incubated at 37° C. in 5% CO2. Culture supernatants were harvested at the indicated hours post-infection. The viral titers of the supernatants at the different time-points were determined by use of plaque assays in MDCK cells.
  • Mini-Genome Luciferase Assay. Polymerase activity was tested with a mini-genome assay by using the dual-luciferase system as previously described in Murakami (2008) and Ozawa et al. (2007). Briefly, 293 cells were transfected with viral protein expression plasmids for NP, PB1, PB2, and PA from the WT−Venus−H5N1 or MA−Venus−H5N1 virus (0.2 μg each), with a plasmid expressing a reporter vRNA encoding the firefly luciferase gene under the control of the human RNA polymerase I promoter (pPoll/NP(0)Fluc(0), 0.2 μg), and with pRL-null (Promega, 0.2 μg), which encodes the Renilla luciferase, as an internal transfection control. At 24 hours post-transfection, cell lysate was prepared with the Dual-Luciferase Reporter Assay System (Promega) and luciferase activity was measured by using the GloMax 96 microplate luminometer (Promega). The assay was standardized against Renilla luciferase activity. All experiments were performed in triplicate.
  • Laboratory facility. All studies with H5N1 viruses were performed in enhanced biosafety level 3 containment laboratories at the University of Tokyo (Tokyo, Japan), which are approved for such use by the Ministry of Agriculture, Forestry, and Fisheries, Japan.
  • Statistical analysis. The data were analyzed by using the R software (www.r-project.org), version 3.1. For comparisons of measurements from multiple groups collected at a single time point, we used one-way ANOVA followed by Tukey's Post hoc test. For comparisons of multiple groups with measurements collected independently at different time-points (i.e., viral growth curves from mice, collected in MDCK cells), we used two-way ANOVA followed by Tukey's Post hoc test. For comparisons of multiple groups with dependent measurements (i.e., viral growth 7 curves in cell culture for which aliquots were collected from the same culture at different time points), a linear mixed-effects model was fitted to the data using the R package NLME, and the time, the virus strain, and the interaction between these two factors were considered. Next, a contrast matrix was built to compare the strains in a pairwise fashion at the same time points (e.g., group_1 vs group_2 at 24 hours post-infection, group_1 vs group_3 at 24 hours post-infection, group_2 vs group_3 at 24 hours post-infection), using the R package PHIA. Because the comparisons were performed individually, the final p-values were adjusted by using Holm's method to account for multiple comparisons. In all cases, the results were considered statistically significant if we obtained In all cases, the results were considered statistically significant if we obtained p-values (or adjusted p-values)<0.05.
  • Sequence analysis. The PB2 and PA sequences from the NCBI Influenza Virus Database were aligned by using the MUSCLE program (Edgar, 2004), with the default parameters and a maximum of 100 iterations. The alignment was visualized by using Clustal X (Larkin et al., 2007), and the frequency of amino acid occurrences at specific positions was determined by using custom written Per scripts.
  • Results Comparison Between WT−Venus−H5N1 and MA−Venus−H5N1 Viruses.
  • As in Example 1, the NS segment of A/Viet Nam/1203/2004 (H5N1) (abbreviated as VN1203) was substituted with a Venus-fused NS segment of Venus−PR8 virus by using reverse genetics, and acquired an H5N1 virus that expressed the Venus fluorescent reporter gene (WT−Venus-1H51N11 virus). A pathogenicity analysis in mice revealed that this virus exhibited attenuated virulence in mice compared with that of the parental VN1203 with an MLD50 value of 103 PFU (compared with 0.7 PFU for VN1203) (FIGS. 6A and 6B and Hatta et al. (2007)). Moreover, WT−Venus−H5N1 virus mainly replicated in respiratory organs (Table 3), and its Venus expression was very weak in both MDCK cells (FIG. 7) and in mice after virus infection (FIG. 8).
  • TABLE 3
    Replication and virulence of H5N1 reassortants and mutants in micea
    Mean virus titer (log10 PFU/g ± SD) on the indicated day p.i.
    Lung Spleen Kidney Brain
    Day
    1 Day 3 Day 1 Day 3 Day 1 Day 3 Day 1 Day 3
    Virus p.i. p.i. p.i. p.i. p.i. p.i. p.i. p.i.
    WT-Venus-H5N1 6.5 ± 0.2  6.3 ± 0.2  b
    MA-Venus-H5N1 9.1 ± 0.1 c 8.9 ± 0.0 c 3.4 ± 0.2 6.5 ± 0.1 2.4 ± 0.1 4.1 ± 0.1 2.8 ± 0.6
    RG-MA 9.1 ± 0.1 c 9.2 ± 0.1 c 2.8 ± 0.4 7.1 ± 0.0 2.3, —, — 4.0 ± 0.1 2.3 ± 0.2
    WT + MA-PB2 7.7 ± 0.0 c 8.0 ± 0.1 c 4.1, 4.4, —
    WT + MA-PA 7.1 ± 0.1 c 6.8 ± 0.1 d
    WT + MA- 8.6 ± 0.3 c 8.7 ± 0.1 c 2.9 ± 0.4 6.8 ± 0.0 2.0, 1.7, — 4.3 ± 0.7 2.7 ± 0.8
    (PB2 + PA)
    aSix-week-old SPF C57/BL6 mice were inoculated intranasally with 105 PFU of each virus in a 50-μl volume. Three mice from each group were euthanized on days 1 and 3 p.i., and virus titers were determined in samples of lung, spleen, kidney, and brain in MDCK cells.
    b —, no virus was isolated from the sample.
    c P value was <0.01 compared with the titers in the lungs of mice infected with WT-Venus-H5N1 virus.
    d P value was <0.05 compared with the titers in the lungs of mice infected with WT-Venus-H5N1 virus.
  • After six passages of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus in mice, MA−Venus−H5N1 virus was obtained. MA−Venus−H5N1 virus was lethal to mice with an MLD50 of 3.2 PFU (Example 1). This virus replicated systemically in mice; on day 1 p.i., high viral titers were detected in lungs, spleens, and kidneys, and on day 3 p.i. virus could be detected in brains (Table 3). Moreover we detected high Venus expression of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus in MDCK cells (FIG. 7) and in mice (FIG. 8). Therefore, compared with WT−Venus−H5N1, MA−Venus−H5N1 virus showed much higher pathogenicity in mice and a higher replicative ability. Moreover, this virus exhibited high Venus expression during its replication in vitro and in vivo.
  • To identify the genetic mutations that had occurred during mouse adaptation, the genome of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus was sequenced and compared to that of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus. At the amino acid level, a total of seven differences were found between the two viruses in their PB1, PB2, PA, NA, M2, and NS1 genes (Table 4). Thus single or multiple amino-acid changes among these seven different amino acids may contribute to the difference in virulence in mice and in Venus expression between these two viruses.
  • TABLE 4
    Amino acid differences between WT-
    Venus-H5N1 and MA-Venus-H5N1 viruses.
    Viral Amino acid Amino acid in:
    segment position WT-Venus-H5N1 MA-Venus-H5N1
    PB2
    25 Val (V) Ala (A)
    PB1 737 Lys (K) Arg (R)
    PA 443 Arg (R) Lys (K)
    NA 35 Ser (S) Arg (R)
    284 Val (V) Leu (L)
    M2 64 Ala (A) Asp (D)
    NS1 167 Pro (P) Ser (S)
  • V25A of PB2 and R443K of PA Determine the Pathogenicity and Venus Expression of Venus−H5N1 Virus in Mice.
  • To investigate the genetic basis for the difference in the virulence and Venus expression of Venus−H5N1 virus after mouse adaptation, a reverse genetics system was established for MA−Venus−H5N1 virus, which was named RG−MA virus. RG−MA virus exhibited similar viral titers in organs, MLD50 value (FIGS. 6C and 6D and FIG. 9), and Venus expression in mice (FIG. 9) to those of its original virus (MA−Venus−H5N1 virus).
  • To identify the amino acids responsible for the difference in virulence and Venus expression between WT−Venus−H5N1 and MA−Venus−H5N1 virus, six single-gene recombinant viruses were generated, each bearing the PB2, PB1, PA, NA, M, or NS gene from MA−Venus−H5N1 virus and the other seven genes from WT−Venus−H5N1 virus. The recombinant viruses that contained the PB1, NA, or NS gene of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus (designated WT+MA−PB1, WT+MA−NA, or WT+MA−NS) displayed similar pathogenicity in mice to that of WT−Venus−H5N1 (MLD50, 103 PFU) (FIG. 9), whereas the reassortants with the PB2, PA, or M gene of MA−Venus−H5N1 (designated WT+MA−PB2, WT+MA−PA, or WT+MA−M) exhibited higher pathogenicity in mice than WT−Venus−H5N1 (FIG. 9). WT+MA−PB2 and WT+MA−PA replicated more efficiently in mouse lungs than did WT−Venus−H5N1; moreover virus was detected in the spleens of two of three mice infected with WT+MA−PB2.
  • The effect of the PB2, PA, or M genes derived from WT−Venus−H5N1 on the virulence of MA−Venus−H5N1 was also examined by generating three single-gene recombinant viruses, each containing the PB2, PA, or M gene from WT−Venus−H5N1 virus and the remaining segments from MA−Venus−H5N1 virus (designated MA+WT−PB2, MA+WT−PA, or MA+WT−M). The MLD50 values of MA+WT−PB2 and MA+WT−PA were 1023 PFU, significantly higher than that of MA−Venus−H5N1 (MLD50, 3.2 PFU), whereas the virulence of MA+WT−M in mice was similar with that of MA−Venus−H5N1 (FIG. 9). These data suggest that the PB2 and PA genes played a role in the pathogenicity of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus in mice.
  • To assess the potential synergetic effects of the PB2 and PA genes on viral pathogenicity in mice, a reassortant carrying both the PB2 and PA genes of MA−Venus−H5N1 [MA−(PB2+PA)] on the WT−Venus−H5N1 virus backbone and a reciprocal reassortant on the MA−Venus−H5N1 virus backbone [designated WT+MA−(PB2+PA) and MA+WT−(PB2+PA)] were rescued, and assessed for virulence in mice. The substitution of the PB2 and PA genes from MA−Venus−H5N1 virus into WT−Venus−H5N1 virus significantly enhanced its virulence in mice, with an MLD50 value of 3.2 PFU (FIG. 9), and also enhanced virus spread and replication in mice, similar to that of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus, and vice versa. Given that a single mutation is present in PB2 and in PA after mouse adaptation, these data indicate that V25A of PB2 and R443K of PA synergistically contribute to the virulence of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus in mice.
  • When checking the Venus expression of the above reassortants in MDCK cells, it was found that the MA−PB2 gene markedly increased Venus expression (FIG. 7). In addition, Venus expression of WT+MA−PB2 virus in the lungs was also appreciably enhanced (FIG. 8). The other single-gene substitutions including MA−PA did not affect Venus expression; however, the double substitution of MA−PB2 and MA−PA on the WT−Venus−H5N1 virus backbone increased Venus expression in MDCK cells and in mouse lung compared with those achieved by WT−Venus−H5N1 and WT+MA−PB2 virus (FIGS. 7 and 8). These data indicate that V25A of the PB2 protein plays a vital role in the Venus expression of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus in vitro and in vivo, and that R443K of the PA protein enhances the PB2 effect on Venus expression.
  • The Amino Acid at Position 25 in the PB2 Protein Significantly Enhances Viral Replication in Mammalian Cells.
  • The replicative ability of these viruses was further examined in MDCK cells and it was found that the MA−Venus−H5N1 virus had similar replicative capability with RG−MA virus and grew more efficiently than WT−Venus−H5N1 virus, and that the titers of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus were significantly higher than those of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus at 36 and 48 hpi (FIG. 10). The contribution of the PB2 and PA viral segments to the replication of the two viruses was then investigated. Significantly higher titers of WT+MA−PB2 and WT+MA−(PB2+PA) were observed compared with those of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus at several time points post-infection, yet the replication efficiency of WT+MA−PA was comparable to that of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus (FIG. 10). The titers of WT+MA−(PB2+PA) were higher than those of WT+MA−PB2 at 36 and 48 hpi although the difference was not statistically significant (FIG. 10). These results indicate that the MA−PB2 gene enhances the replication of Venus−H5N1 virus in MDCK cells, and that this increase can be further enhanced by the presence of MA−PA, although MA−PA alone does not alter virus replication in MDCK cells.
  • The Mutations in the Polymerase Genes after Mouse Adaptation Decrease Viral Polymerase Activity in Mammalian Cells.
  • The polymerase activity of the viral ribonucleoprotein (RNP) complex has been correlated with viral replication and virulence (Gabriel et al., 2005; Leung et al., 2010; Li et al., 2008; Salomen et al., 2006). The activity of the eight RNP combinations of PB1, PB2, and PA from either WT−Venus−H5N1 or MA−Venus−H5N1 virus was determined by measuring luciferase activity. The polymerase activity of the mouse-adapted virus was near 4-fold less than that of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus (FIG. 11). The substitution of any MA gene decreased the activity of the polymerase complex of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus, but the polymerase activity of complexes containing the double substitution of MA−PB2 and MA−PA was significantly decreased compared with that of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus and was similar with that of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus. These results indicate that the polymerase activity of RNP complexes was notably decreased after mouse adaptation, which is not in agreement with the enhanced replication and virulence.
  • Molecular Determinants of Venus Stability in Venus−H5N1 Virus In Vitro and In Vivo.
  • To assess Venus stability in the WT−Venus−H5N1 and RG−MA viruses in vitro, the two viruses were passaged five times in MOCK cells. During these passages Venus-negative plaques were picked up from WT−Venus−H5N1 virus, but not from RG−MA virus, suggesting that the Venus gene is more stable after mouse adaptation (Table 5). To identify the molecular determinants of this Venus stability, various reassortants were passaged five times in MOCK cells. Venus-negative plaques were acquired from reassortants with the MA−PB1, MA−NA, or MA−M gene, but we did not obtain any Venus-negative plaques from the fifth passages of Venus−H5N1 virus with the MA−PB2, MA−PA, MA−(PB2+PA), or MA−NS gene (Table 5). These data suggest that the MA−PB2, −PA, and −NS genes may play roles in Venus stability.
  • TABLE 5
    Venus stability in Venus-H5N1 reassortants in MDCK cellsa.
    No. of
    No. of No. of No. of Venus-negative
    passages in plaques Venus-negative plaques after
    Virus MDCK cells checked plaques picked recheck
    WT-Venus-H5N1 2 73 5 4
    3 111 5 1
    4 79 5 0
    5 61 12 2
    RG-MA 2 66 1 0
    3 144 8 0
    4 73 1 0
    5 75 2 0
    WT + MA-PB2 5 84 2 0
    WT + MA-PB1 5 126 4 1
    WT + MA-PA 5 104 16 0
    WT + MA-(PB2 + PA) 5 123 6 0
    WT + MA-NS 5 199 11 0
    WT + MA-NA 5 73 16 1
    WT + MA-M b 5 69 10 10
    aEach virus was passaged five times in MDCK cells as describe in the Materials and Methods. Venus expression of different passage stocks was detected in MDCK cells by using fluorescence microscopy. Venus-negative plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells. Amplified Venus-negative plaques were rechecked for Venus expression to exclude false-negative plaques.
    b 69 plaques of the fifth passage stock of WT + MA-M were checked by using fluorescence microscopy, all of which were “Venus-negative”. Ten of these plaques were picked up to further confirm the lack of Venus expression, all of which were confirmed to be Venus-negative.
  • To further evaluate the roles of these different genes on Venus stability, the NS segments of the fifth-passage stocks from different reassortants were amplified by using PCR and NS-specific primers. Except for the Venus-NS segment (1.9 kb), the deleted NS segments were detectable, at a level similar to that for the NS segment of PR8, at less than 1 kb. The deleted NS segments of WT−Venus−H5N1 and of the reassortants with the MA−NA and MA−M genes were much brighter than those of the other reassortants (FIG. 12), further implying that the MA−NA and MA−M genes do not contribute to Venus stability in vitro. Although RG−MA virus and the reassortants with MA−NS, MA−PA, or MA−PB2 were more stable, the deleted Venus-NS segments were still amplified by using PCR albeit to a lesser degree (FIG. 12). The deleted NS segments from the various reassortants were extracted and sequenced, and the different deletion forms were identified from the different reassortants (FIG. 13).
  • In addition, to examine Venus stability in vivo, B6 mice were inoculated with 105 PFU of WT−Venus−H5N1 virus, RG−MA virus, or WT+MA−(PB2+PA) virus. Lungs were collected on day 4 p.i., before the mice died, and were homogenized in PBS. The supernatants were inoculated into MDCK cells, and at 48 hpi Venus-negative plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells. It should be noted that sometimes the Venus signal of the plaque correlates with the condition of the cultured cells and the detection time. Therefore the Venus expression of amplified Venus-negative plaques was rechecked in MDCK cells to exclude false negatives. More than 95 plaques were detected from each lung, and only one plaque without Venus expression was acquired from one of three mice infected with RG−MA virus, twelve Venus-negative plaques from three mice infected with WT+MA−(PB2+PA), and more than 15 Venus-negative plaques from each mouse infected with WT−Venus−H5N1 virus (Table 6). These results indicate that WT−Venus−H5N1 virus is the most unstable of these viruses in vivo, and that the PB2 and PA genes from MA−Venus−H5N1 virus enhance Venus stability, albeit to a lesser extent than occurs in MA−Venus−H5N1 virus. The mutations on PB1, PB2, PA, and NS may therefore synergistically contribute to Venus stability in MA−Venus−H5N1 virus in vivo.
  • TABLE 6
    Venus stability in Venus-H5N1 viruses in micea.
    No. of
    No. of No. of Venus-negative
    Mouse plaques Venus-negative plaques after
    Virus No. checked plaques picked recheck
    RG-MA 1# 105 4 1
    2# 109 6 0
    3# 127 5 0
    WT + MA-(PB2 + PA) 4# 116 12 6
    5# 111 8 3
    6# 115 14 3
    WT-Venus-H5N1 7# 145 31 22
    8# 120 27 18
    9# 95 19 15
    aSix-week-old SPF C57/BL6 mice were infected intranasally with 105 PFU of each virus in a 50-μl volume.

    Three mice from each group were euthanized on day 4 p.i. and their lung tissues were collected and homogenized in PBS. The supernatants of the lung samples were inoculated into MDCK cells to check for Venus expression, and Venus-negative plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells. Amplified Venus-negative plaques were rechecked for Venus expression to exclude false-negative plaques.
  • Discussion
  • Previously, a visualizable H5N1 virus expressing a Venus reporter gene that became more lethal to mice and more stable after mouse adaptation was constructed (Example 1). In this study, the whole genome of this virus (MA−Venus−H5N1) was sequenced, and seven amino acids that differed from the WT−Venus−H5N1 virus sequence were identified. To explore the molecular determinants for the differences in virulence and Venus expression in mice between these two viruses, a series of reassortants of both viruses was generated using reverse genetics. The double mutation of PB32 (V25A) and PA (R443K) was found to dramatically enhance the pathogenicity of WT−Venus−H5N1 in mice. V25A of P1B2 also significantly increased Venus expression and viral replication in MDCK cells and in mice, and that R443K of PA further enhanced these effects. The stability of different reassortants was examined in vitro, the reassortants with MA−PB2, MA−PA, or MA−NS were found to be more stable. These results suggest that the PB32 and PA proteins play roles in the pathogenicity and Venus stability of Venus-expressing H5N1 viruses in mammalian hosts.
  • The pathogenicity of highly pathogenic H5N1 avian influenza viruses in mammals is determined by multiple viral genes. For example, the HA protein plays crucial roles in the systemic replication and lethal infection of H5 subtype viruses in chickens (Kawaoka and Webster, 1988) and mammals (Hatta et al., 2001; Suguitan et al., 2012). The HA and NS genes of H5N1 virus also contribute to high virulence in ferrets (Imai et al., 2010). The NS1 protein helps to subvert the antiviral immune response of the host and is essential for the pathogenicity of H5N1 viruses in mice (Jiao et al., 2005). Mutations in the M1 protein also affect the virulence of H5N1 viruses in mice (Fan et al., 2009). The amino acids at position 627 and 701 of PB2 are key determinants of the high virulence of H5N1 influenza viruses in mammals (Hatta et al., 2001; Li et al., 2005). Lastly, the PA protein is reported to contribute to the virulence of H5N1 avian influenza viruses in domestic ducks (Song et al., 2011) and in mice (Hu et al., 2013). Here, it was found that V25A of PB2 and R443K of PA synergistically contribute the pathogenicity of H5N1 virus in mice.
  • Based on all of the influenza virus sequences (23514 PB2 proteins and 24240 PA proteins) available in the public database (www.fludb.org), it was found that 25V in PB2 and 443R in PA are extremely conserved, whereas 25A in PB2 is present in only two viruses [A/Mallard/ON/499/2005(H5N1), accession number EF392844; and A/Zhejiang/92/2009(H1N1), accession number CY095997] and 443K in PA is present in only one strain, isolated from a quail [A/Quail/Shantou/1425/2001(H9N2), accession number EF154846]. Although the virulence of these viruses in mice is unknown, the present study is the first to suggest that the combination of 25A in PB2 and 443K in PA contributes to the increased virulence of a virus in mice and is a unique feature of MA−Venus−H5N1 virus.
  • The RNA polymerase of influenza A virus consists of the PB1, PB2, and PA subunits, and is implicated in numerous essential processes in the viral life cycle (Naffakh et al., 2005). PB1 performs polymerase and endonuclease activities, PB2 is responsible for capped-RNA recognition, and PA is involved in RNA replication and proteolytic activity (Obayasjo et al., 2005). The interfaces of these polymerase subunits are essential for transcription initiation (He et al., 2008; Sugiyama et al., 2009). Residues 1-37 at the N-terminus of the PB2 protein play a vital role in binding to the PB1 protein and affect the RNA polymerase activity, and these residues are highly conserved among all subtypes of influenza virus (Sugiyama et al., 2009). The amino acid at position 25 of PB2 is located within the third α-helix (amino acids 25 to 32) of its PB1-binding domain (Sugiyama et al., 2009). In this study, the amino acid at position 25 in PB2 was found to be changeable, and V25A in PB2 was found to increase viral replication in mammalian cells and in mice, resulting in higher pathogenicity of the H5N1 virus in mice. The R443 residue of the PA protein also plays a role in replication activity (Obayashi et al., 2008; Regan et al., 2006), and the mutation R443A in PA prevents the production of infectious virus (Regan et al., 2006). In this study, reassortants with R443K in their PA protein were rescued, and demonstrated that R443K in PA enhances viral replication in mouse lungs, reinforcing it was the virulence of H5N1 virus in mice. The present data thus further emphasize the role of the amino acid at position 443 of the PA protein for influenza virus.
  • Earlier reports have shown that the polymerase activity of the viral RNP complex closely correlates with viral replication and virulence (Gabriel et al., 2005; Leung et al., 2010; Li et al., 2008; Salomon et al., 2006). Viruses with higher polymerase activity in mammalian cells generally show higher virulence in mice (Zhang et al., 2014) and ferrets (Salomen et al., 2006). However, viruses with high polymerase activity are not always lethal to mice, which suggests that high pathogenicity of a virus in its host may require a certain level of polymerase activity (Gabriel et al., 2005). In this study, it was found that MA−Venus−H5N1 virus was more lethal to mice than was its wild-type counterpart, yet it had much lower polymerase activity, and any RNP combination with a polymerase gene from MA−Venus−H5N1 also had lower activity. These results may imply that the polymerase activity of the vRNP complex closely correlates with the viral genome, and that the lower level of polymerase activity is more compatible with the reconstructed genome of Venus−H5N1, which benefits its high pathogenicity in mice.
  • With the development of living imaging in vivo, the ability to visualize influenza viruses carrying fluorescent reporter genes will be of great benefit influenza virus-related research (Heaton et al, 2013; Helft et al., 2012; Manicassamy et al., 2010; Pan et al., 2013; Example 1). An effective virus for this purpose should have good replicative ability and show considerable pathogenicity in its host. Moreover, it should both highly and stably express its fluorescent reporter protein. Many attempts to construct influenza A viruses carrying the GFP reporter gene have been reported (Kittel et al., 2004; Manicassamy et al., 2010); however, some of these viruses showed low replication or poor pathogenicity in mice (Kittle et al., 2004), while some produced relatively low fluorescent signals or did not stably express GFP during virus replication in vitro and in vivo (Manicassamy et al., 2010). The present data demonstrate that not only is MA−Venus−H5N1 virus highly pathogenic to mice, but it also highly and stably expresses Venus fluorescent protein in vitro and in vivo. In the present analysis of the molecular determinants of Venus expression and Venus stability, it was found that V25A in PB2 played a role in determining Venus expression, which was further enhanced by the presence of R443K in PA. The analysis of Venus stability revealed that the single gene of MA−PB1, −PB2, −PA, or −NS determines Venus stability in vitro, but in vivo the situation is more complex and mutations in PB1, PB2, PA, and NS may synergistically codetermine Venus stability in MA−Venus−H5N1 virus.
  • In summary, molecular determinants in a mouse-adapted Venus−H5N1 virus were identified that play a crucial role in the pathogenicity of the virus in mice, and in its Venus expression and Venus stability in vitro and in vivo. These molecular markers will benefit future research on anti-influenza virus drug and vaccine development.
  • Example III Materials and Methods
  • Cells and viruses. Madin-Darby canine kidney (MDCK) cells were maintained in minimum essential medium (MEM) containing 5% of newborn calf serum (NCS). Human embryonic kidney 293T (HEK293T) and HEK293 cells were maintained in Dulbecco's modified Eagle medium supplemented with 10% fetal calf serum (FCS). A/Puerto Rico/8/34 (H1N1; PR8) (Horimoto et al., 2007) and each NS1−Venus PR8 virus were generated by using reverse genetics and were propagated in MDCK cells at 37° C. for 48 hours in MEM containing L-(tosylamido-2-phenyl) ethyl chloromethyl ketone (TPCK)-treated trypsin (0.8 μg/mL) and 0.3% bovine serum albumin (BSA) (Sigma Aldrich).
  • Adaptation of NS1−Venus PR8 virus in mice. Six- to eight-week-old female C57BL/6 mice (Japan SLC) were intranasally infected with 50 μL of 2.3×106 plaque-forming units (PFU) of NS1−Venus PR8 virus. Lungs were harvested 3-6 days post-infection (dpi) and homogenized in 1 mL of phosphate-buffered saline (PBS). To obtain a clone with high proliferative ability and Venus expression, plaque purification of the lung homogenate using MDCK cells was performed. A large, highly Venus-expressing plaque was picked and the cloned virus was propagated in MDCK cells at 37° C. for 48 hours, then 50 μL of the supernatant was used as an inoculum for the next passage. These procedures were repeated six times.
  • Sequence analysis. Sequence analysis of viral RNA was performed as described previously (Sakabe et al., 2011). Briefly, viral RNAs were extracted by using a QIAamp Viral RNA mini kit (QIAGEN) and Superscript III™ reverse transcriptase (Invitrogen) and an oligonucleotide complementary to the 12-nucleotide sequence at the 3′ end of the viral RNA (Katz et al., 1990) were used for reverse transcription of viral RNAs. Each segment was amplified by using PCR with Phusion High Fidelity DNA polymerase (Finnzymes) and primers specific for each segment of the PR8 virus. The PCR products were purified and their sequences determined by using ABI 3130xl (Applied Biosystems).
  • Plasmid construction and reverse genetics. Plasmids containing the cloned cDNAs of PR8 genes between the human RNA polymerase I promoter and the mouse RNA polymerase I terminator (referred to as Poll plasmid) were used for reverse genetics and as templates for mutagenesis. The mutations found in NS1-Venus PR8 virus after passage were introduced into the plasmid constructs of PR8 by using site-directed mutagenesis (referred to as pPoIIR-PR8−PB2−E712D and pPolIR-PR8−HA−T380A, respectively). Reverse genetics was performed as described previously (Neumann et al., 1999). The eight Poll plasmids were cotransfected into HEK293T cells together with eukaryotic protein expressing plasmids for PB2, PB1, PA, and NP derived from PR8 by using the TransIT-293 transfection reagent (Mirus). Forty-eight hours after transfection, the supernatant was harvested and propagated once in MDCK cells at 37° C. for 48 hours in MEM containing TPCK-treated trypsin (0.8 □g/mL) and 0.3% BSA. Cell debris was removed by centrifugation at 2,100×g for 20 minutes at 4° C., and the supernatants were stored at −80° C. until use. The virus titers were determined by means of a plaque assay using MDCK cells.
  • Polykaryon formation assay. Polykaryon formation assay was performed as described previously (Imai et al., 2012) with modifications. HEK293 cells propagated in 24-well plates were infected with wild-type PR8 or PR8 possessing the hemagglutinin (HA) mutation found in NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus in DMEM containing 10% FCS at a multiplicity of infection (MOI) of 10. At 18 hours post-infection, cells were washed with MEM containing 0.3% BSA and treated with TPCK-treated trypsin (1 μg/mL) in MEM containing 0.3% BSA for 15 minutes at 37° C. to cleave the HA on the cell surface into HA1 and HA2. Trypsin was inactivated by washing the cells with DMEM containing 10% FCS. To initiate polykaryon formation, cells were exposed to low-pH buffer (145 mM NaCl, 20 mM sodium citrate (pH 6.0-5.4)) for 2 minutes at 37° C. Then the low-pH buffer was replaced with DMEM containing 10% FCS and the cells were incubated for 2 hours at 37° C. The cells were then fixed with methanol and stained with Giemsa's solution. A microscope mounted with a digital camera (Nikon) was used to obtain photographic images.
  • Western blotting. MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1 without trypsin. The cells were lysed with Novex® Tris-Glycine SDS sample buffer (Invitrogen) 12 hours after infection and subjected to SDS-polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis. Then, the proteins were transferred to a PVDF membrane in transfer buffer (100 mM Tris, 190 mM glycine). After membrane blocking, the membranes were incubated with a rabbit anti-GFP polyclonal antibody (MBL) or rabbit antiserum to A/WSN/33(H1N1)(R309), which was available in our laboratory. This antiserum reacts with influenza viral proteins including HA, NP, and matrix protein (M1). After incubation with the primary antibodies followed by washing with PBS containing 0.05% Tween-20 (PBS-T), the membranes were incubated with ECL™ anti-rabbit IgG HRP-linked whole antibody (GE Healthcare). Finally, specific proteins were detected by using the ECL Plus Western Blotting Detection System (GE Healthcare). The VersaDoc Imaging System (Bio-Rad) was used to obtain photographic images.
  • Pathogenicity and replication of viruses in mice. Six-week-old female C57BL/6 mice were intranasally infected with 50 μL of 103, 104 or 105 PFU of each virus. Four mice per group were monitored for survival and body weight changes for 14 days after infection. Three mice per group were infected with 103 PFU of each virus and euthanized on the indicated days. Their lungs were collected to determine viral titers by means of plaque assay on MDCK cells.
  • Immunofluorescence assay. Six-week-old female C57BL/6 mice were intranasally infected with 50 μL of 104 PFU of each virus. Three mice per group were euthanized on the indicated days. To fix the lungs, they were intratracheally injected with 800 μL of 4% paraformaldehyde (PFA) phosphate buffer solution and then removed. After incubation with 10 mL of 4% PFA at 4° C. for 4 hours, the buffer was replaced with 10%, 20%, and 30% sucrose in PBS in a stepwise fashion. Then lungs were embedded in Optimum Cutting Temperature (OCT) Compound (Tissue-Tek) and frozen in liquid nitrogen. Frozen sections (6 μm in thickness) were permeabilized in 0.2% Triton X-100 in PBS and incubated with primary antibodies at 4° C. for 12 hours. Primary antibodies were goat anti-Clara cell 10 kDa protein (CC10) (Santa Cruz, sc-9772), rabbit anti-surfactant protein C (SP-C) (Santa Cruz, sc-13979), golden Syrian hamster anti-podoplanin (eBioscience, eBio8.1.1), and rabbit anti-calcitonin gene-related peptide (CGRP) (Sigma-Aldrich, C8198). After being washed with PBS, the sections were incubated with species-specific fluorescence dye-conjugated secondary antibodies at room temperature for 30 minutes. Nuclei were stained with Hoechst33342 (Invitrogen). A Nikon A1 confocal microscope (Nikon) was used to observe the sections.
  • Preparation of transparent samples. Transparent samples were prepared by using SCALEVIEW A2 (Olympus) in accordance with a previous report (Hama et al., 2012). Six-week-old female C57BL/6 mice were intranasally infected with 50 μL of 105 PFU of each virus. Intracardial perfusion was performed on the indicated days and lungs were fixed with 4% PFA in PBS for 4 hours at 4° C. Lungs were incubated with 10%, 20%, and 30% sucrose in PBS as described above, embedded in OCT compound, and frozen in liquid nitrogen. After the samples were thawed and rinsed in PBS, they were fixed again with 4% PFA in PBS for 30 minutes at room temperature. Then the lungs were transferred to SCALEVIEW A2 and incubated at 4° C. for at least 2 weeks. SCALEVIEW A2 was exchanged every 2-3 days. Transparent samples were observed by using a stereo fluorescence microscope (Leica M205FA) mounted with a digital camera (DFC365FX) and filter GFP 3 (480/40 LP510).
  • Flow cytometry. To prepare single-cell suspensions, lungs were minced with scissors and digested with 20 mg of collagenase D (Roche) and 200 units of DNase (Worthington) for 30 minutes at 37° C. Samples were then passed through 100-sm cell strainers and red blood cells were lysed by red blood cell lysis buffer (Sigma Aldrich). Single-cell suspensions were stained with a combination of the following antibodies: allophycocyanine-conjugated anti-F4/80 (eBioscience, BM8), allophycocyanine-cyanine 7-conjugated anti-CD11b (BioLegend, M1/70), phycoerythrin-cyanine 7-conjugated anti-CD11c (BD PharMingen, HL3), and eFluor 450-conjugated CD45 (eBioscience, 30-F11). Dead cells were stained with via-probe (Becton Dickinson). Stained samples were analyzed with FACSAria II (Becton Dickinson and Company) and FlowJo software (TreeStar).
  • RNA isolation and integrity. Venus-positive and -negative cells from three pooled lungs were collected in TRIzol Reagent (Invitrogen). Total RNA was extracted by isopropanol precipitation with glycogen as a carrier. Isolated total RNA integrity was assessed by determining UV 260/280 absorbance ratios and by examining 28S/18S ribosomal RNA bands with an Agilent 2100 bioanalyzer (Agilent Technologies) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
  • Microarray analysis. Forty nanograms of total RNAs was amplified by using the Arcturus® Riboamp® Plus RNA Amplification Kit (Life technologies). Cy3-labeled complementary RNA probe synthesis was initiated with 100 ng of total RNA by using the Agilent Low Input Quick Amp Labeling kit, one color (Agilent Technologies) according to the manufacturer's instructions. The Agilent SurePrint G3 Gene Mouse GE 8×60 K microarray was also used. Slides were scanned with an Agilent's High-Resolution Microarray Scanner, and image data were processed by using Agilent Feature Extraction software ver. 10.7.3.1. All data were subsequently uploaded into GeneSpring GX ver 12.5 for data analysis. For the data analysis, each gene expression array data set was normalized to the in silico pool for samples from mice inoculated with PBS. Statistically significant differences in gene expression between the Venus-positive cells and -negative cells were determined by using one-way analysis of variance (ANOVA) followed by the Turkey HSD post-hoc test (P<0.05) and the Benjamin-Hochberg false discovery rate correction. Differentially expressed genes were further filtered to include genes whose expression changed 2.0-fold relatively to the level in the PBS group. Genes that passed the statistical analysis were further assigned to a gene ontology (GO) grouping.
  • Results
  • Establishment of a mouse-adapted NS1−Venus PR8 virus. Although NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus was successfully rescued by reverse genetics, this virus was avirulent in mice (MLD50: >105 PFU), and the expression of Venus was very weak in MDCK cells and in the lung sections of mice infected with this virus. To increase the virulence and Venus expression of NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus, the virus was serially passed in mice via intranasal infection with plaque-purified high Venus-expressing clones (see Examples I and II). After six serial passages, the virulence of the virus appeared to have increased; therefore, this mouse-adapted NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus was sequenced to look for mutations.
  • The sequence analysis revealed that two amino acid substitutions had occurred after passaging (Table 7).
  • TABLE 7
    Amino acid substitutions in NS1-Venus PR8 MA virus.
    amino acid encoded
    Protein amino acid position PR8 NS1-Venus PR8 MA
    PB2 712 E D
    HA 380 T A

    One of the mutations was in PB2 (a glutamine acid-to-asparagine acid substitution at position of 712), and the other was in HA (a threonine-to-alanine substitution at position of 380). To confirm their contribution to pathogenicity in mice, these mutations were introduced into a correspondent poll plasmid, and reverse genetics used to generate NS1−Venus PR8, which possessed the two mutations (referred to as NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus). The pathogenicity of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus was higher than that of NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus (MLD50: 2.1×10W PFU). Furthermore, the Venus signal in the lungs from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus was strong, whereas in the lung infected with NS1−Venus PR8 WT and that infected with PR8, no Venus signal was detected (data not shown). NS1−Venus PR8 MA, therefore, showed promise as a useful reporter virus.
  • Comparison of mutant virus replication in MDCK cells. To compare the growth of these viruses in a cell line, two single-gene reassortants were generated that possessed the PB2 or HA gene of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus and the remaining genes from NS-Venus PR8 WT virus for use in experiments with the NS1-Venus PR8 WT and NS1−Venus PR8 MA viruses. MDCK cells were infected with these viruses at an MOI of 0.001 and viral titers in supernatants were determined every 12 hours by means of a plaque assay (FIG. 14). Although NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus grew to 106.5 PFU/mL, NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus grew to more than 108 PFU/mL, comparable to wild-type PR8 virus. While the viral titers of NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 virus and NS1-Venus PR8 HA virus reached approximately 1075 PFU/mL, these were lower than that of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus. Therefore, the growth capability of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus was remarkably improved in MDCK cells, and the mutations in the PB2 and HA genes acted in an additive manner.
  • Comparison of the pathogenicity and replication in mice of the mutant viruses. Next, to assess their pathogenicities, C57BL/6 mice were infected with 105, 104 or 103 PFU of these viruses and monitored their body weights and survival (FIG. 15). The body weights of the mice infected with 105 PFU of these viruses dramatically decreased and 1 out of 4 mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus and all of the mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus had to be euthanized during the observation period. In addition, mice infected with 104 PFU of NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus showed pronounced body weight loss, and 1 out of 4 mice infected with NS1−Venus MA virus and 2 out of 4 mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 virus succumbed to their infection. On the other hand, although the body weights of the mice infected with 104 PFU of NS1−Venus PR8 HA and NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus decreased slightly, all of the mice survived. In the case of infection with 103 PFU, while the body weights of the mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1−Venus PR8 MA decreased slightly, all of these mice also survived. Mice infected with 103 PFU of NS1−Venus PR8 WT and NS1−Venus PR8 HA showed little body weight loss, and all of the mice survived. The viral titers of these viruses were determined in mouse lung (FIG. 16). Mice were infected with 103 PFU of the viruses and lungs were collected on days 3, 5, and 7 after infection. The maximum virus lung titer from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 virus was >106 PFU/g, which was similar to that from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus. In contrast, virus titers in lungs from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 WT and NS1−Venus PR8 HA virus were significantly lower than those in lungs from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus at all time points. Finally, viruses were not detected in lungs from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 WT at 7 days after infection. Taken together, these results demonstrate that only the PB2 mutation affected the pathogenicity and replication of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus in mice.
  • The stability of Venus expression by NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus during replication in vitro and in vivo. In the Manicassamy study (Manicassamy et al., 2010), the proportion of GFP-negative virus increased over time. This is one of the obstacles to utilizing this virus for live imaging studies. The stability of Venus expression by NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus was assessed during replication in MDCK cells (FIG. 17A). More than 90% of plaques were Venus-positive even 72 hours after infection. The positive rate of Venus expression was monitored during repeated passages of the virus in cell culture (FIG. 17B). Approximately 90% of plaques expressed Venus even after 5 passages, suggesting that Venus expression by NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus was stable in cell culture. Finally, Venus expression was confirmed to be stable during virus replication in vivo (FIG. 17C). A plaque assay was performed using lung homogenates and estimated the positive rate of Venus expression essentially as described above. Although the percentage of Venus-positive plaques was more than 85% at 3 days after infection, that of Venus-positive plaques was approximately 75% at 7 days after infection. Taken together, these results indicate that Venus expression by NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus is stable during replication in vitro, and the percentage of Venus-positive plaques in mouse lung was similar to that reported previously (Manicassamy et al., 2010).
  • The PB2−E712D substitution is responsible for high Venus expression. The Venus expression level of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus was substantially higher than that of NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus. Since PB2 is one of the subunit of the influenza virus polymerase, it was hypothesized that the PB2−E712D substitution was important for the augmentation of Venus expression. To compare the Venus protein expression, western blots of the viral protein and Venus in infected cells were performed (FIG. 18A). Twelve hours post-infection, although the amount of M1 protein was similar for all of the viruses, the amount of Venus protein was higher in cells infected with NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus compared with the other two viruses that possessed the parental PB2 gene. Venus expression in infected cells was also observed by using a confocal laser microscope (FIG. 18B). As expected, the Venus signals in the cells infected with NS1−Venus PR8 PB2 and NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus were stronger than in the cells infected with the two viruses that possessed parental PB2 gene. Taken together, these results demonstrate that the PB2−E712D substitution was responsible for the high Venus expression.
  • To demonstrate that the PB2−E712D mutation increased the Venus expression levels, MDCK cells were infected with the indicated viruses at an MOI of 1 and performed confocal microscopy 12 hours later (FIG. 18C). As expected, the levels of the NS1−Venus fusion protein were higher in cells infected with MA−Venus−PR8 or PB2-Venus−PR8 than in those infected with WT−Venus−PR8 or HA-Venus−PR8 (FIG. 18C).
  • Collectively, the data indicate that the PB2−E712D substitution is primarily responsible for the increased replicative ability, Venus expression, and virulence in mice of MA−Venus−PR8 virus. To assess whether the PB2−E712D mutation directly affects the viral polymerase activity in a minireplicon assay, HEK293 cells were transfected with viral protein expression plasmids for NP, PA, PB1, and PB2 or PB2−E712D, together with a plasmid expressing a vRNA encoding the firefly luciferase gene; the pRL-null luciferase protein expression plasmid (Promega) served as a transfection control. Luciferase activities were measured by using a Dual-Glo luciferase assay system (Promega) at 48 hours post-transfection (Ozawa et al., 2007). Unexpectedly, the polymerase activity of PB2−E712D was lower than that of the parental PB2 (FIG. 18D). Similar results were obtained with canine MDCK cells (data not shown). In the context of a minireplicon that measures viral replication and transcription, the PB2−E712D mutation is thus attenuating; in contrast, this mutation enhances viral growth in the context of replicating virus. These findings indicate that the PB2 protein functions not only in viral replication/transcription, but performs additional roles in the viral life cycle.
  • The HA−T380A substitution raises the threshold for membrane fusion. The HA vRNA of MA−Venus−PR8 did not significantly increase the virulence of WT−Venus−PR8 in mice; however, HA-Venus−PR8 virus grew more efficiently in MDCK cells than WT−Venus−PR8 (FIG. 14), suggesting a contribution of the HA-T380A mutation to, at least, virus replication in cultured cells. Because the HA−T380A substitution is located on an a-helix in the HA2 subunit (Gamblin et al., 2004), its effect on HA membrane-fusion activity was evaluated by using a polykaryon formation assay (Imai et al., 2012). Briefly, HEK293 cells were infected with WT−PR8 or a mutant PR8 virus encoding HA−T380A at an MOI of 10. Eighteen hours later, cells were treated with TPCK-treated trypsin (1 μg/mL) for 15 minutes at 37° C., exposed to low-pH buffer (145 mM NaCl, 20 mM sodium citrate (pH 6.0-5.4)) for 2 minutes, incubated for 2 hours in maintenance medium at 37° C., fixed with methanol, and stained with Giemsa's solution. The wild-type HA had a threshold for membrane fusion of pH 5.5, whereas the threshold for HA−T380A was pH 5.8 (FIG. 19), leading to the conformational change in HA at an earlier stage of endosome maturation during influenza virus entry (Lozach et al., 2011). Changes in the pH threshold for membrane fusion may affect HA thermostability (Ruigrok et al., 1986), an effect that we did not observe at 50° C. (data not shown).
  • Time-course observation of virus propagation in whole mouse lung. NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus allows the observation of virus-infected cells without immunostaining because the Venus expression by this virus is sufficiently high to permit the visualization of infected cells with a microscope. To observe how influenza virus propagates in the lung, transparent lungs are treated with SCALEVIEW A2, a reagent that make samples optically transparent without decreasing fluorescence intensity were used (FIG. 20). Mice were intranasally infected with 105 PFU of PR8, NS1−Venus PR8 WT, and NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus, and lungs were collected on days 1, 3, and 5 after infection. After treatment with SCALEVIEW A2, the samples were observed using a stereo fluorescence microscope. Venus signals that were directly observed were ambiguous because of insufficient transparency. Therefore, the transparent samples were dissected in the direction of the long axis to expose the bronchi (FIG. 20, lower panel, “cut”). Venus expression was not observed in the transparent samples from mice infected with NS1−Venus PR8 WT virus at any time point (FIGS. 20G and H). Samples collected at 3 days post-infection are shown. In the case of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus-infected lungs, although Venus signals were not observed at 1 day post-infection (FIGS. 20A and B), Venus expression was clearly observed in a large portion of the epithelial cells of the bronchi at 3 days post-infection (FIGS. 20C and D). Venus expression was also occasionally observed in alveolar epithelial cells around the bronchus. At 5 days post-infection, most of the Venus-positive cells found in the bronchial epithelium had disappeared and the number of Venus-positive cells in the bronchiole and alveoli had increased (FIGS. 20E and F). On the basis of these observations, it may be that the Venus-positive cells found in the bronchi at 3 days post-infection died and the influenza virus spread from the bronchi to the bronchioles and alveoli over time. No obvious Venus signals were observed in the transparent lungs from the mice inoculated with PR8 or PBS (FIGS. 201-L). These results demonstrate that NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus and transparent reagent SCALEVIEW A2 permit the visualization of the dynamics of influenza virus infection in whole lung lobes.
  • Identification of the target cells of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus in mouse lung. Transparent lungs infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus revealed that influenza virus first infected the bronchial epithelium and subsequently invaded the alveoli over time. Next, to identify the target cells of NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus, an immunofluorescence assay of frozen sections was performed using several antibodies specific for lung cells (FIG. 21). The epithelial cells of the bronchi and bronchioles include Clara cells, ciliated cells, goblet cells, and a small number of neuroendocrine cells, whereas alveoli comprise type I and type II alveolar epithelial cells. Of these cell types, I focused on Clara cells and type II alveolar epithelial cells because Clara cells constitute the bulk of the lumen of bronchi and bronchioles (Rawlins et al., 2006), and type II alveolar epithelial cells have previously been reported to be a target of influenza virus (Baskin et al., 2009). At 3 days post-infection, a large proportion of the bronchiole cells were Venus-positive and almost all of these cells were CC10-positive (FIG. 21A). In addition, cuboidal Venus signals in the alveolar regions were merged with SP-C positive cells (FIG. 21B, white arrowheads). Although rare, Venus-positive type I alveolar epithelial cells were observed at 5 days post-infection (FIG. 21B, white arrow). However, Venus expression in neuroendocrine cells was never detected (data not shown).
  • Flow cytometry was performed to determine whether alveolar macrophages and monocytes were infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus, because these immune cells are present in lung and function as the first line of defense against inhaled microbes and particulates. Alveolar macrophages were distinguished monocytes on the basis of the CD11b expression level in the F4/80+ population (FIG. 22A). Mice were infected with 105 PFU of PR8 or NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus and the total number of these cells were compared. After influenza virus infection, although the number of alveolar macrophages was rarely different from that of the control group, the number of monocyte dramatically increased because monocytes infiltrated sites of infection from blood vessels (FIGS. 22B and C). As to the proportion of Venus-positive cells, 3.16%±0.59% of the alveolar macrophages were Venus-positive cells and 1.55%±0.07% of the monocytes were Venus-positive at 3 days post-infection (FIGS. 22D and E). Further, the number of Venus-positive cells decreased slightly between 3 days and 5 days after NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus infection. For the PR8 infection, the number of Venus-positive cells was comparable to that in mock-treated mice. Taken together, these results demonstrate that the Clara cells in the bronchus and bronchiolus, type II alveolar epithelial cells, monocytes, and alveolar macrophages in the alveolar regions of the lung are target cells of influenza virus.
  • Differential gene expressions between Venus-positive and -negative cells in the F4/80+ cell population. Because alveolar macrophages and monocytes act as the first line of defense against inhaled microbes, it is possible that infection of these cells with influenza virus might influence their ability to prevent the spread of infection. To assess this, the gene expression profiles between the Venus-positive and -negative cells among the alveolar macrophage and monocyte populations were compared by means of microarray analysis. Because the number of Venus-positive alveolar macrophages and monocytes that could be collected from one mouse by using flow cytometry was too small to perform a microarray analysis, these cells were analyzed together as F4/80+ cells and pooled from three mice. Live mononuclear cells were gated as CD45+ and via-probe cells. As shown in FIG. 22A, the cells were confirmed as alveolar macrophages and monocytes on the basis of CD11b expression levels in the F4180+ population. Venus-positive and -negative F4/80 cells were sorted from a fraction of the live mononuclear cells by FACSAria II. Since CD11chigh alveolar macrophages possess high autofluorescence, the possibility existed for overlap with the Venus signal. Therefore, CD11chigh alveolar macrophages with intermediate expression of Venus were excluded from the Venus-positive fraction (FIG. 23A). From confocal microscopic observation of the sorted cells, these cells could be collected properly based on Venus expression (FIG. 23B). In addition, given that Venus expression was observable throughout the cell, these cells would have been infected with virus, but did not engulf the infected cells. The microarray analysis revealed thousands of genes whose expression statistically changed at least 2.0-fold relative to the level of F4/80+ cells from mice inoculated with PBS (data not shown). Among these genes, 633 genes whose expression statistically differed by at least 4.0-fold between Venus−positive and -negative F4/80+ cells were identified (FIG. 24A). Gene Ontology analysis revealed that these genes were involved in extracellular activity (FIG. 248). For genes annotated in “cytokine activity,” a total of 24 genes had changed expression levels, including several cytokines, such as type I interferon (IFN), and chemokines (FIG. 24C). All of these genes except for the genes for interleukin (IL)-4 and Cxcl13 [chemokine (C—X—C motif) ligand 13] were up-regulated in Venus-positive cells relative to Venus-negative cells. Moreover, when I focused on the genes annotated in “response to wounding”, most genes including those for collagen type 1α1 (Col1a1), collagen type 3α1 (Col3a1), collagen type 5α1 (Col5a1), hyaluronoglucosamidase 1 (Hyal1), and fibrinogen γ chain (Fgg) were up-regulated in Venus-positive F4/80+ cells (FIG. 24D). Taken together, these results demonstrate that a small number of cells relative to the total number of F4/80+ cells was infected with influenza virus and that the gene expression levels of several cytokines and chemokines were enhanced in the virus-infected cells at the site of infection. Furthermore, F4/80+ cells infected with NS1−Venus PR8 MA virus enhanced the expression of genes involved in the response to wounding which would be caused by infection and inflammation.
  • Example IV
  • A vector is described above that can express a heterologous gene product from a fusion construct with the viral NS1 protein (FIG. 26). In particular, a PB2−E712D mutation stabilized expression of a heterologous gene product. The test virus, WT−Venus−PR8, was serially passaged to identify other mutations in the polymerase complex which contribute to stabilization (FIG. 27).
  • Example V
  • An E-to-D mutation at position 712 of the polymerase subunit PB2 (PB2−E712D) stabilized the inserted Venus gene (Fukuyama et al., 2015; Katsura et al., 2016). Also, a H5N1 virus carrying the Venus gene, which was inserted into the NS segment from PR8 (Venus−H5N1), was prepared (Fukuyama et al., 2015). Although, like WT−Venus−PR8, WT−Venus−H5N1 showed moderate virulence and low Venus expression, we acquired a variant that became more lethal to mice and stably expressed Venus after mouse adaptation. A V-to-A mutation at position 25 of the polymerase subunit PB2 and a R-to-K mutation at position 443 of the polymerase subunit PA contributed to the stable maintenance of the Venus gene (Zhao et al., 2015). These results indicated that the composition of the viral polymerase plays a role in the stabilization of the inserted foreign gene. However, the mechanisms by which the Venus gene can be deleted and how polymerase mutations stabilize the Venus gene have remained unknown.
  • As disclosed below, the mechanisms of Venus gene stabilization were investigated by comparing events upon infection with WT−Venus−PR8 and Venus−PR8 possessing the PB2−E712D mutation (Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D). Polymerase fidelity and RNA and protein expression in infected cells were examined, and sequencing analysis coupled with coinfection experiments were performed to determine how the Venus gene is deleted. Moreover, additional mutations that contribute to the stabilization of the Venus gene were identified to further the understanding of the stabilization mechanisms.
  • Materials and Methods
  • Cells and viruses. Madin-Darby canine kidney (MDCK) cells were cultured in minimal essential medium (Gibco) with 5% newborn calf serum at 37° C. in 5% CO2. Human embryonic kidney 293T (HEK293T) cells were cultured in Dulbecco's modified Eagle medium supplemented with 10% fetal calf serum. WT-Venus−PR8 and Venus−PR8 mutants with NS segments encoding the Venus fluorescent protein (Fukuyama et al., 2015) were generated by using reverse genetics (Neumann et al., 1999) and propagated in MDCK cells at 37° C.
  • Venus stability. MDCK cells were infected with WT−Venus−PR8 or each Venus−PR8 mutant at an MOI of 0.001. The supernatants were collected at 48 h postinfection and titrated by using plaque assays in MDCK cells. Obtained viruses were similarly passaged four times. The proportion of Venus-expressing plaques in virus stocks from different passages was determined in MDCK cells by observing more than 65 plaques in each virus stock using fluorescence microscopy. To exclude false-positive plaques, Venus-negative plaques were picked up, amplified in MDCK cells, and reassessed for Venus expression.
  • Deep sequencing analysis WT−PR8, PR8−PB2−E712D, PR8−PB1−V43I (Cheung et al., 2014; Naito et al., 2015), and PR8−PB1−T123A (Pauly et al., 2017) were generated by reverse genetics (Neumann et al., 1999), and MDCK cells were infected at an MOI of 0.001. The supernatants were collected at 48 h postinfection and titrated by using plaque assays in MDCK cells. The obtained viruses were passaged five times in the same way. Virus RNA was extracted from viruses before passaging and from viruses passaged five times by using a QIAamp viral RNA minikit (Qiagen). Reverse transcription-PCR (RT-PCR) was performed by using a Superscript III high-fidelity RT-PCR kit (Invitrogen). DNA amplicons were purified by 0.45× of Agencourt AMpure XP magnetic beads (Beckman Coulter), and 1 ng was used for barcoded library preparation with a Nextera XT DNA kit (Illumina). After bead-based normalization (Illumina), libraries were sequenced on the MiSeq platform in a paired-end run using the MiSeq v2, 300 cycle reagent kit (Illumina). The raw sequence reads were analyzed by using the ViVan pipeline (Isakov et al., 2015). Here, a cutoff of 1% as the minimum frequency was used. Moreover, we defined an empirical cutoff for the minimum read coverage: for a variant with 1% frequency, at least 1,000 reads should cover that region. Likewise, for a variant with 0.1% frequency, 10,000 reads should cover that region. Namely, if the coverage was <1,000/(frequency), the variant was removed. The sequencing data of the five-times passaged viruses were compared to those of the viruses before passaging. The number of nucleotide mutations that were not observed before passaging but observed only after passaging was counted. The number of mutations per nucleotide was calculated for each segment and the mean values for all eight segments in each virus were compared.
  • Quantitative real-time PCR. MDCK cells were infected with WT−Venus−PR8 or Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D at an MOI of 1 or mock infected with medium. The total RNA was extracted from cells at 9 h postinfection by using an RNeasy minikit (Qiagen). Quantification of RNA was performed as described previously (Kawakami et al., 2011). The primers for IFN-β, NS vRNA, NP vRNA, and β-actin were described previously (Kawakami et al., 2011; Kupke et al., 2018; Park et al., 2015). Data were analyzed with the 2−ΔΔCT method (Livak et al., 2001) and normalized to the expression of β-actin mRNA.
  • Western blotting. MDCK cells were infected with each virus at an MOI of 1 or mock infected with medium. Cells were lysed at the indicated time points with Tris-glycine SDS sample buffer (Invitrogen). The cell lysates were sonicated, heated for 10 min at 95° C., and then subjected to SDS-PAGE. SDS-PAGE was performed on Any kD Mini-PROTEAN TGX precast protein gels (Bio-Rad). Proteins on SDS-PAGE gels were transferred to a polyvinylidene fluoride membrane (Millipore) and detected by using the indicated primary antibodies (rabbit anti-NS1 [GeneTex], mouse anti-Aichi NP [2S 347/4], mouse anti-R-actin [Sigma-Aldrich]), followed by secondary antibodies (sheep horseradish peroxidase [HRP]-conjugated anti-mouse IgG [GE Healthcare] or donkey HRP-conjugated anti-rabbit IgG [GE Healthcare]). Signals of specific proteins were detected by using ECL Prime Western blotting detection reagent (GE Healthcare). Images were captured with a ChemiDoc Touch imaging system (Bio-Rad) and quantified by using Image Lab software (Bio-Rad). Coinfection analysis. Three nucleotides in the 3′ or 5′ region, which does not overlap the packaging signal sequence (Fujii et al., 2005) of the NS segment of WT−Venus−PR8, were substituted synonymously. These modified viruses were used to coinfect MDCK cells at an MOI of 0.001 each or an MOI of 5 each. The supernatant was collected at 2 days or 8 h postinfection, respectively, and infected to MDCK cells. Venus−negative plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells, and then the sequences of the NS segments in the obtained viruses were analyzed.
  • Identification of additional mutations that stabilize the Venus gene. WT−Venus−PR8 was infected to MDCK cells at an MOI of 0.001. The supernatant was collected at 2 days postinfection and infected to MDCK cells. Next, Venus-positive plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells repeatedly until mutants stably expressing Venus fluorescence were obtained. The sequences of the mutants were analyzed to identify amino acid mutations in PB2, PB1, and PA. To determine whether these mutations contributed to the stability of the Venus gene, mutants containing each of the identified amino acid mutations were generated by reverse genetics (Neumann et al., 1999), and the Venus stability of each mutant was examined as described above. Confirmed amino acid positions were plotted on the crystal structure of the influenza virus polymerase complex (PDB ID 4WSB) by using the PyMOL molecular graphics system. In FIG. 32B, the polymerase internal tunnels were visualized by using the MOLEonline web interface (Pravda et al., 2018), and the information was deposited in ChannelsDB (Pravda et al., 2018). The percentage of strains that contained the identified amino acid was determined by using the “Sequencing Feature Variant Type” tool in the Influenza Research Database (Zhang et al., 2017; Noronha et al., 2012).
  • Statistical analysis. Statistically significant differences between WT−Venus−PR8 and Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D were assessed by using a two-tailed unpaired Student t test. A P value of <0.05 was considered significantly different.
  • Results
  • Loss of Venus expression in WT−Venus−PR8 restores replication efficiency. WT−Venus−PR8 and Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D were prepared by using reverse genetics as previously described (Neumann et al., 1999). The gene of the Venus fluorescent protein was inserted into the NS segment as illustrated in FIG. 28A (Fukuyama et al., 2015). First, it was confirmed how quickly Venus expression was lost in WT−Venus−PR8 and the relationship between Venus deletion and virus titer. The viruses were passaged in MDCK cells at a multiplicity of infection (MOI) of 0.001 and the proportion of Venus-positive plaques measured (FIG. 288). It was confirmed that the expression of Venus was lost immediately in WT−Venus−PR8, whereas all plaques of Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D showed Venus expression after four passages. Although WT−Venus−PR8 showed a lower titer than Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D in MDCK cells, as described previously (Katsura et al., 2016), the virus titer increased during virus passages as the proportion of Venus-positive plaques decreased (FIG. 28C).
    This result suggests that the loss of the Venus gene in the mutated WT−Venus−PR8 restored the replicative efficiency of the virus.
    The PB2−E712D Mutation does not Cause an Appreciable Change in Polymerase Fidelity.
    It was hypothesized that the PB2−E712D mutation increases viral polymerase fidelity in order to retain the inserted Venus gene during passages. To test this hypothesis, WT−PR8, as well as PR8−PB2−E712D, which possesses aspartic acid at position 712 of PB2 and therefore differs from WT−PR8 by only this amino acid, were generated by reverse genetics and their mutation rates compared. Here, viruses were used that did not contain the Venus gene to make it easier to measure the mutation rates. PR8−PB1−V43I, which has been reported to be a high-fidelity mutant virus (Cheung et al., 2014; Naito et al., 2015), and PR8−PB1−T123A, which has been reported to be a low-fidelity mutant virus (Pauly et al., 2017), were also generated by reverse genetics and used as controls. To estimate the mutation rates, these viruses were passaged in MDCK cells at an MOI of 0.001 and deep sequencing of the entire genome performed; the sequencing data for the five-times passaged viruses were compared to those of viruses before passaging. The number of nucleotide changes in the five-times passaged viruses that were not present before passaging were counted. The number of mutations introduced during the five passages are shown in FIG. 29A by segment. Also, the number of mutations per nucleotide was calculated for normalization, and the mean values for all eight segments were compared (FIG. 29B). It was confirmed that PR8−PB1−V43I, the high-fidelity control, had fewer mutations, and that PR8−PB1−T123A, the low-fidelity control, had more mutations than WT−PR8. Although PR8−PB1−V43I had fewer mutations than WT−PR8, the difference between PR8−PB1−V43I and WT−PR8 was small. Since a previous report suggested that PB1−V43I does not alter the mutation rate (Pauly et al., 2017), the influence of PB1−V43I on the mutation rate might be dependent on the virus strain or experimental conditions. Moreover, there was no clear difference in mutation number between WT−PR8 and PR8−PB2−E712D. Although the possibility that the PB2−E712D mutation affects virus polymerase fidelity cannot be excluded, the effect does not seem to be large enough to cause an appreciable difference in Venus stability. Therefore, this result suggests that the stability of the Venus gene is not influenced by the fidelity of the virus polymerase.
  • Transcription/Replication of the Modified RNA Segment is Impaired in WT−Venus−PR8.
  • Some reports suggest that recombinant viruses containing a foreign gene insertion in their NS segment can propagate more efficiently in interferon (IFN)-deficient Vero cells than in IFN-competent cells such as MDCK cells (Kittel et al., 2004; Ferko et al., 2001; Kuznetsova et al., 2014). Therefore, the expression levels of IFN-S in virus-infected cells was quantified by using quantitative real-time PCR. MDCK cells were infected with WT-Venus−PR8 or Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D at an MOI of 1 or mock infected with medium only, and the relative expression levels of IFN-s in infected cells were quantified at 9 h postinfection. WT−Venus−PR8 induced a higher level of IFN-β expression than did Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D (FIG. 30A). This result suggests that WT-Venus−PR8 does not efficiently inhibit IFN-β expression. Given that NS1 plays a key role in suppressing IFN expression and IFN-mediated antiviral responses in the host (Garcia-Sastre et al., 1998; Opitz et al., 2007), the NS vRNA in infected cells was quantified by using influenza virus strand-specific real-time PCR (Kawakami et al., 2011; Kupke et al., 2018). The amount of NS vRNA in WT−Venus−PR8-infected cells was 90% lower than that in Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D-infected cells (FIG. 30B), whereas there was no significant dierence in their NP vRNA expression levels (FIG. 30C). The NS vRNA/NP vRNA ratio in WT−Venus−PR8-infected cells was 80% lower than that in Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D-infected cells (FIG. 30D). This result suggests that the transcription/replication of the NS segment is specifically impaired in WT−Venus−PR8. The sequences of all of the plasmids used to generate viruses by reverse genetics were confirmed before use, and the NS segments of WT−Venus−PR8 and Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D were derived from the same NS-Venus plasmid. Therefore, it is unlikely that either WT−Venus−PR8 or Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D has a mutated promoter sequence in its NS segment. Accordingly, the difference in the transcription/replication efficiency of the NS segment was likely caused by the PB2−E712D. Moreover, it was confirmed the expression level of the NS1 protein by Western blotting (FIG. 30E). Due to the reduced transcription/replication efficiency of the NS segment, the expression level of the NS1 protein in WT−Venus−PR8-infected cells was much lower than that in Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D-infected cells. In contrast, the expression level of NP was almost the same. The NS1/NP ratio, quantified based on the band intensity, was significantly reduced in WT−Venus−PR8-infected cells (FIG. 30F). It therefore appears that the low level of NS1 expression leads to the high expression of IFN-β in WT−Venus−PR8-infected cells. Furthermore, the high expression of IFN-β causes attenuation of WT-Venus−PR8, although it is possible that other factors are involved.
  • The Inserted Venus Gene is Deleted Via Internal Deletion.
  • To explore how deletion of the Venus gene occurs, the sequence of the NS segment in WT−Venus−PR8 that lost Venus expression after serial passages was determined. Plaque assays were performed using three independently passaged WT−Venus−PR8 virus stocks and it was found that the majority of the plaques were Venus negative. More than five plaques from each stock were sequenced and it was found that one or two deletion patterns were in each virus stock. Large deletions occurred in the NS segment and most of the Venus sequence was lost (FIG. 31A). However, no specific patterns with regard to the deletion, such as the number of nucleotide deletions, the site of the deletion(s), or specific sequences at which deletions occurred, were identified. It was hypothesized that the large deletion resulted from internal deletion caused by polymerase jumping, which is a known mechanism of defective interfering viral RNA production (Davis et al., 1980; Jennings et al., 1983), or by gene recombination, which plays a role in RNA virus adaptation through rearrangement of the virus genome (Xiao et al., 2016; Simon et al., 2011; Mitanul et al., 2000; Khatchikian et al., 1989). Synonymous mutations were introduced into the 3′ or 5′ region of the NS segment of WT−Venus−PR8 (FIG. 31B) and then MDCK cells were infected at an MOI of 0.001 or 5 with each of these mutant viruses, after which supernatants were collected at 2 days or 8 h postinfection, respectively. The supernatant was then incubated with MDCK cells. Venus-negative plaques were picked up and amplified in MDCK cells, and then we determined the NS segment sequence in the viruses that lost Venus expression. We found that the truncated NS segments had a synonymous mutation on only one side (FIG. 31C). No viruses were found that had NS segments with synonymous mutations on both sides or without a synonymous mutation in both low- and high-MOI coinfections. This result indicates that the large deletion in the NS segment resulted from internal deletion in each NS segment and not gene recombination between NS segments.
  • Additional Mutations Stabilize the Venus Gene.
  • To further understand the mechanisms of the Venus deletion and stabilization, additional mutations were attempted in the polymerase complex that stabilizes the Venus gene. MDCK cells were infected with WT-Venus−PR8 at an MOI of 0.001, and then Venus-positive plaques were picked and amplified in MDCK cells. After consecutive passaging and plaque purification of Venus-positive viruses, mutants were obtained that stably expressed enhanced Venus fluorescence. Sequence analysis revealed that mutations were introduced into the polymerase genes PB2, PB1, and PA of each mutant (FIG. 32A). PA-180 and PA-200 are located on the surface of the polymerase complex, as is PB2-712, whereas PB2-540, PB1-149, and PB1-684 are located inside the complex. PA-180 and PA-200 are located in the endonuclease domain, PB1-149 and PB1-684 are located near the exit of the RNA template, and PB2-540 is located near the exit of newly synthesized RNA products (FIG. 32B), while the function of the region around PB2-712 has remained unclear (Reich et al., 2014; Pflug et al., 2017; Gerlach et al., 2015). To determine whether these mutations contribute to the stabilization of the Venus gene, mutant viruses were generated containing each of the mutations by using reverse genetics and measured the Venus retention ratio after four passages in MDCK cells (FIG. 32C). The mutant viruses showed enhanced Venus stability compared to WT−Venus−PR8, indicating that these amino acids play roles in the stabilization of the Venus gene. Although further analysis is needed to clarify how these amino acids contribute to the stability of the Venus gene, considering that PB2-540, PB1-149, and PB1-684 are located near the polymerase internal tunnels (Reich et al., 2014; Pflug et al., 2017; Gerlach et al., 2015) that the template and product go through during the transcription/replication reaction, these amino acids may affect the binding stability of the RNA template, product, and polymerase complex. Moreover, when we examined whether these mutations were found in previously isolated influenza A viruses in the Influenza Research Database (FIG. 32D), we found that these amino acids are extremely rare, suggesting that they are not evolutionarily beneficial.
  • Discussion
  • Recombinant influenza viruses expressing foreign genes would be useful tools; however, long insertions in virus genomes are often unstable and cause attenuation of the recombinant viruses. We previously found that amino acids in the influenza virus polymerase complex play crucial roles in the stabilization of foreign gene insertions; the Venus gene inserted into the NS segment was stabilized by PB2−E712D in an H1N1 virus (Fukuyama et al., 2015; Katsura et al., 2016) and by PB2-V25A and PA-R443K in an H5N1 virus (Zhao et al., 2016). However, the mechanisms by which these amino acids contribute to the stabilization remained unclear. In the present study, we explored the mechanism of PB2−E712D-induced stabilization of the Venus gene inserted into the NS segment of an H1N1 virus. It was found that the transcription/replication efficiency of the modified segment was significantly reduced in WT−Venus−PR8 compared to Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D. This finding suggests that the PB2−E712D mutation stabilizes the inserted foreign gene due to the enhanced transcription/replication efficiency of the modified RNA segment. In contrast, the transcription/replication efficiency of segments that do not contain additional sequences is not changed in the presence or absence of the PB2−E712D mutation. Moreover, polymerase activity is reduced, not enhanced, by the PB2−E712D mutation in a minireplicon assay (Katsura et al., 2016). These results indicate that the alteration of the transcription/replication efficiency caused by PB2−E712D is specific to modified RNA segments. The insertion of foreign genes appears to impair the transcription/replication of the modified segments, and the polymerase overcomes this impairment in the presence of the PB2−E712D mutation.
  • In WT−Venus−PR8, in which the Venus gene is inserted into the NS segment, the transcription/replication efficiency of this segment is significantly reduced. As a result, the expression of the NS1 protein is also reduced. Since NS1 plays a role in inhibiting IFN-mediated antiviral responses (Garcia-Sastre et al., 2008; Optiz et al., 2007) WT−Venus−PR8 cannot inhibit IFN-(3 expression efficiently, which may lead to virus attenuation. The viral titer of WT−Venus−PR8 increases during serial passages in MDCK cells as the virus loses Venus expression (FIGS. 28B and 28C), suggesting that mutated WT−Venus−PR8 that does not contain the Venus gene propagates more efficiently than the original WT−Venus−PR8. Therefore, it is likely that the immediate loss of Venus expression in WT−Venus−PR8 results from the selection of variants without the Venus gene during serial passaging. Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D restores the transcription/replication efficiency of the NS segment, leading to efficient virus replication. Therefore, viruses expressing Venus are not purged by selective pressure in the presence of the PB2−E712D mutation, which enables Venus−PR8-PB2−E712D to stably maintain the inserted Venus gene.
  • How is the transcription/replication efficiency reduced on modified RNA segments specifically, and how is it enhanced by the PB2−E712D mutation? The RNA secondary structure and the binding affinity between the polymerase complex and the RNA templates likely hold the answer to these questions. Insertion of a foreign gene must change the RNA secondary structure, and transcription/replication by the viral polymerase complex may be negatively influenced by this unusual RNA secondary structure. Although we do not conclusively know how the PB2−E712D mutation overcomes the impairment of transcription/replication, one possible explanation is that the binding affinity between the polymerase complex and the RNA templates is increased.
  • The sequence analysis of WT−Venus−PR8 that lost Venus expression, coupled with the coinfection experiments (FIGS. 29B and 29C), suggested that the inserted sequence is deleted due to an internal deletion. Internal deletions often occur during influenza virus replication cycles regardless of the presence of a foreign gene insertion and have been reported to play roles in virus adaptation (Lui et al., 1993; Lui et al., 1985; Yang et al., 1987) and the generation of defective interfering viral RNA (Davis et al., 1980; Jennings et al., 1983). Internal deletion is believed to be caused by polymerase complex dissociation from RNA templates during transcription/replication (Jennings et al., 1983; Lazarini et al., 2001; Dimmock et al., 2014; Lopez et al., 2014). Amino acid mutations in the polymerase complex affect the frequency of occurrence of internal deletions (Fodor et al., 2003; Vasilijevic et al., 2017; Slaine et al., 2018; Te Velthuis et al., 2018). PB2−E712D may also be involved in the occurrence of internal deletions. Therefore, the stabilization of the Venus gene in Venus−PR8−PB2−E712D may be caused not only by the enhancement of the transcription/replication on the modified segment but also by the reduced frequency of internal deletions.
  • Additional mutations in the influenza virus polymerase complex were identified that stabilize the inserted Venus gene, which may help us to further understand the stabilization mechanisms based on the positions of these mutations in the viral polymerase complex. Some of the identified amino acids are located near the polymerase internal tunnels, which are near the RNA template or newly synthesized RNA product during the transcription/replication reactions (Reich et al., 2014; Pflug et al., 2017; Gerlach et al., 2015). These amino acids might directly affect the binding affinity between the polymerase complex, template, and product. A previous report, which showed that PB2 amino acids located at the template exit channel are involved in the formation of short aberrant RNAs (Te Velthuis et al., 2018), supports the possibility that amino acids near the polymerase internal tunnels affect the binding affinity between the polymerase complex, template, and product. However, PA-180 and PA-200, which are located at the endonuclease domain, are not near the polymerase internal tunnels, which is also true for PB2-712. Therefore, these amino acids may affect the binding affinity indirectly, or there may be other mechanisms involved in the stabilization of the Venus gene. These mutations could be used to establish recombinant influenza viruses expressing a foreign gene. However, these amino acids may not necessarily cause the stabilization of a foreign gene in all influenza virus strains, since PB2-V25A, which stabilizes the Venus gene in Venus−H5N1, had a negative effect on virus replication in Venus−PR8 and did not cause Venus stabilization (our unpublished data).
  • Although the identified amino acids seem to enhance the genetic stability of virus genomes, they have been rarely found in virus isolates (FIG. 32D). It seems likely that mutations that support the maintenance of inserted sequences are not evolutionarily beneficial to the virus. Insertions of additional sequences into virus genomes are often deleterious for virus replication. These mutations are probably rare in virus populations to avoid the accumulation of deleterious insertions. Viruses may purge deleterious insertions by reducing the transcription/replication efficiency of RNA segments that contain insertions that form abnormal secondary structures. In conclusion, although the amino acid mutations we identified in this study are useful for generating recombinant viruses, they do not seem to be beneficial to the virus in nature in the long run.
  • REFERENCES
    • Arilor et al., J. Virol., 86:1433 (2010).
    • Avilov et al., Vaccine, 34:741 (2012).
    • Basler et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 98:2746 (2001).
    • Chen et al., The Lancet, 383:714 (2014).
    • Dias et al., Nature, 458:914 (2009).
    • Diebold et al., Science, 303:1529 (2004).
    • Dos Santos Afonso et al., Virology, 341:34 (2015).
    • Edgar, Nucl Acids Res., 32:1792 (2004).
    • Fan et al., Virology, 384:28 (2009).
    • Fujii et al., J. Virol., 79:3766 (2005).
    • Fukuyama et al., Nat. Comm., 6:6600 (2015).
    • Fukuyama & Kawaoka, Curr. Opin. Immunol., 23:481 (2011).
    • Gabriel et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 102:18590 (2005).
    • Gambotto et al., Lancet, 371:1464 (2008).
    • Garcia-Sastre, Virus Res., 162:12 (2011).
    • Ghaznavi et al., Annu. Rev. Pathol., 8:331 (2013).
    • Go et al., BMC genomics, 13:627 (2012).
    • Hatta et al., PLoS Pathog., 3:1374 (2007).
    • Hatta et al., Science, 293: 1840 (2001).
    • He et al., Nature, 454:1123 (2008).
    • Heaton et al., J. Virol., 87:8272 (2013).
    • Helft et al., J. Clin. Invest., 122:4037 (2012).
    • Herold et al., J. Exp. Med., 205:3065 (2008).
    • Honda & Taniguchi, Nat. Rev. Immunol., 6:644 (2006).
    • Hu et al., J. Virol., 87:2660 (2013).
    • Imai et al., PLoS Pathog., 6:e1001106 (2010).
    • Isakova-Sivak et al., Clin. Vaccine Immunol., PMID:24648485, epub Mar. 19 (2014).
    • Itoh et al., Nature, 460:1021 (2009).
    • Jiao et al., J. Virol., 82:1146 (2008).
    • Jobsis, Science, 198:1264 (1977).
    • Kaimal et al., Nucleic Acids Res., 38:W96 (2010).
    • Kawaoka and Webster, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 85:324 (1988).
    • Kawaoka et al., J. Virol., 63:4603 (1989).
    • Kittel et al., Virology, 324:67 (2004).
    • Larkin et al., Bioinform., 23:2947 (2007).
    • Leung et al., Virology, 401:96 (2010).
    • Li et al., J. Virol., 79:12058 (2005).
    • Li et al., J. Virol., 80:11115 (2006).
    • Li et al., J. Virol., 82:11880 (2008).
    • Li et al., J. Virol., 84:8389 (2010).
    • Li et al., N. Eng. J. Med., 370:520 (2013).
    • Liu et al., Zhonghna si Yan, 26:70 (2012).
    • Manicassamy et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 107:11531 (2010).
    • Murakami et al., J. Virol., 82:1605 (2008).
    • Naffakh et al., Annu. Rev. Microbiol., 62:403 (2008)
    • Nagai et al., Nat. Biotechnol., 20:87 (2002).
    • Neumann et al., Cell Res., 20:51 (2010).
    • Neumann et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 96:9345 (1999).
    • Obayashi et al., Nature, 454:1127 (2008).
    • Ozawa et al., J. Virol., 81:30 (2007).
    • Pan et al., Nature Commun., 4:2369 (2013).
    • Patterson et al., J. Cell. Sci., 114:837 (2001).
    • Perez et al., J. Virol., 78:3083 (2004).
    • Perrone et al., PLoS Pathog., 4:e1000115 (2008).
    • Pichlmair et al., Science, 314:997 (2006).
    • Reed and Muench, Am. J. Hyg., 27:493 (1938).
    • Regan et al., J. Virol., 80:252 (2006).
    • Salomon et al., J. Exp. Med., 202:689 (2006).
    • Scholtissek et al., Virology, 87:13 (1978).
    • Shaner et al., Nat. Biotechnol., 22:1567 (2004).
    • Shieh et al., Am. J. Pathol., 177:166 (2010).
    • Shinya et al., J. Virol., 78:3083 (2004).
    • Smith et al., Nature, 459:1122 (2009).
    • Smyth, Stat. Appl. Genet. Mol. Biol., 3:3 (2004).
    • Song et al., J. Virol., 85:2180 (2011).
    • Sugiyama et al., EMBO J., 28:1803 (2009).
    • Suguitan et al., J. Virol., 86:2706 (2012).
    • Wang et al., PLoS One, 7:e52488 (2010).
    • Watanabe et al., J. Virol., 77:10575 (2003).
    • Watanabe et al., Nature, 501:551 (2013).
    • Wei et al., Vaccine, 29:7163 (2011).
    • Weissleder, Nature Biotech., 19:316 (2001).
    • Wright and Kawaoka, Fields Virology 6th edition, (Philadelphia, Pa., 2013).
    • Yamayoshi et al., J. Virol., 88:3127 (2013).
    • Yu et al., J. Virol., 85:6844 (2011).
    • Zhang et al., J. Gen. Virol., 95:779 (20141
    • Zhang et al., Science, 341:410 (2013).
    • Zhao et al., Proteomics, 12:1970 (2012).
  • All publications, patents and patent applications are incorporated herein by reference. While in the foregoing specification, this invention has been described in relation to certain preferred embodiments thereof, and many details have been set forth for purposes of illustration, it will be apparent to those skilled in the art that the invention is susceptible to additional embodiments and that certain of the details herein may be varied considerably without departing from the basic principles of the invention.

Claims (20)

1. An isolated recombinant influenza virus having PA, PB1, PB2, NP, NS, M, NA, and HA viral segments, wherein i) at least one of the viral segments is a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced stability and/or enhanced replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue at position 180 in PA that is glutamine, a residue at position 200 in PA that is threonine, a residue at position 149 in PB1 that is valine, a residue at position 684 in PB1 that is glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 in PB1 that is aspartic acid; ii) at least one of the viral segments is a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, and wherein at least one of the other viral segments is a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced stability and/or enhanced replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue in PB2 at position 712 that is glutamic acid, a residue at position 180 in PA that is glutamine, a residue at position 200 in PA that is threonine, a residue at position 149 in PB1 that is valine, a residue at position 684 in PB1 that is glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 in PB1 that is aspartic acid; or iii) the recombinant virus has two or more viral segments comprising a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, wherein the recombinant influenza virus has enhanced stability and/or enhanced replication relative to a corresponding recombinant influenza virus with a residue at position 540 in PB2 that is asparagine, a residue in PB2 at position 712 that is glutamic acid, a residue at position 180 in PA that is glutamine, a residue at position 200 in PA that is threonine, a residue at position 149 in PB1 that is valine, a residue at position 684 in PB1 that is glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 in PB1 that is aspartic acid.
2. The virus of claim 1 wherein the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, D, E, Q, or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, N, Q, S, H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, E, N, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, G, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, C, S, M, F, P, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, S, H, T, Y, C, K, R, or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K, S, T, Y, C, or Q; the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R, H, D, S, H, T, Y, or C, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, K, H, R, Q, or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K, D, N, S, H, T, Y, or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G, S, M, or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L, S, M, or G, the residue at position 684 is D, Q, H, L, R or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E, N, R, H, K or Q; or the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
3. The virus of claim 1 wherein the PB2 has a residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, the PA has a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine and a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, and the PB1 has a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid; the PB2 has a residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, the PA has a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, and the PB1 has a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid; the PB2 has a residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at 712 that is not aspartic acid, the PA has a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine and a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, and the PB1 has a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid; or the PB2 has a residue at position 540 that is not asparagine and a residue at 712 that is not aspartic acid, the PA has a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, and the PB1 has a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid.
4. The virus of claim 1 wherein the PA further comprises a residue at position 443 that is not arginine, the PB1 further comprises a residue at position 737 that is not lysine, the PB2 further comprises a residue at position 25 that is not valine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, the NS viral segment encodes a NS1 with a residue at position 167 that is not proline, the HA viral segment encodes a HA with a residue at position 380 that is not threonine, or any combination thereof.
5. The virus of claim 4 wherein the residue at position 443 of PA is K or H, the residue at position 737 of PB1 is H or R, the residue at position 25 of PB2 is A, L, T, I, or G, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D, the residue at position 167 of NS1 is S, C, M, A, L, I, G or T, or any combination thereof.
6. The virus of claim 1 wherein at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
7. The recombinant virus of claim 6 wherein the heterologous sequence is in the NS viral segment, M viral segment, NP viral segment, PA viral segment, PB1 viral segment, or the PB2 viral segment.
8. A vaccine having the isolated recombinant virus of claim 1.
9. The vaccine of claim 8 wherein the virus encodes a non-influenza microbial protein,
a heterologous influenza protein or a cancer associated antigen.
10. A plurality of influenza virus vectors for preparing a reassortant, comprising
a) a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB1 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB2 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus HA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NP DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus M DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, and a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NS cDNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, wherein the PB1, PB2, or PA DNAs in the vectors for vRNA production encode at least one of: a PB2 viral segment encoding PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, a PA viral segment encoding PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 viral segment encoding PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or a combination thereof; and optionally
b) a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB2, and a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NP, and optionally a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus HA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M2, or a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NS2.
11. The vectors of claim 10 wherein the PB1, PB2, PA, NP, NS, and M DNAs in the vectors for vRNA production have a sequence corresponding to one that encodes a polypeptide having at least 95% amino acid sequence identity to a corresponding polypeptide encoded by SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15.
12. The vectors of claim 10 wherein the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
13. The vectors of claim 10 wherein at least one of the viral segments includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
14. A method to prepare influenza virus, comprising: contacting a cell with:
a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB1 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus PB2 DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus HA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NP DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NA DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus M DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, and a vector for vRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to an influenza virus NS DNA linked to a transcription termination sequence, wherein the PB1, PB2, or PA DNAs in the vectors for vRNA production encode
i) a PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, and at least one: a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, ii) a PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine, a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof, or iii) two or more of: a PB2 with residue at position 540 that is not asparagine or a residue at position 712 that is not glutamic acid, a PA with a residue at position 180 that is not glutamine or a residue at position 200 that is not threonine, or a PB1 with a residue at position 149 that is not valine, a residue at position 684 that is not glutamic acid or a residue at position 685 that is not aspartic acid, or any combination thereof; and optionally
a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus PB2, and a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NP, and optionally a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus HA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NA, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M1, a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus M2, or a vector for mRNA production comprising a promoter operably linked to a DNA segment encoding influenza virus NS2;
in an amount effective to yield infectious influenza virus.
15. The method of claim 14 wherein the cell is an avian cell or a mammalian cell.
16. The method of claim 15 wherein the cell is a Vero cell, a human cell or a MDCK cell.
17. The method of claim 14 wherein the wherein the PB1, PB2, PA, NP, NS, and M DNAs in the vectors for vRNA productions have a sequence that corresponds to one that encodes a polypeptide having at least 95% amino acid sequence identity to a corresponding polypeptide encoded by SEQ ID NOs:1-6 or 10-15.
18. The method of claim 14 wherein the residue at position 540 of PB2 is K, R or H, the residue at position 712 of PB2 is D or N, the residue at position 180 in PA is R, K or H, the residue at position 200 in PA is A, I, L, G or V, the residue at position 149 in PB1 is A, T, I, L or G, the residue at position 684 is D or N, or the residue at position 685 in PB1 is E or Q.
19. The method of claim 14 wherein the influenza virus includes a heterologous gene sequence encoding a gene product.
20. The method of claim 19 wherein the heterologous sequence is 5′ or 3′ to the PA coding sequence in the PA viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB1 coding sequence in the PB1 viral segment, 5′ or 3′ to the PB2 coding sequence in the PB2 viral segment or 5′ or 3′ to the NS1 coding sequence in the NS viral segment.
US17/578,939 2019-01-23 2022-01-19 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses Abandoned US20220241396A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US17/578,939 US20220241396A1 (en) 2019-01-23 2022-01-19 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201962795821P 2019-01-23 2019-01-23
US16/749,910 US11241492B2 (en) 2019-01-23 2020-01-22 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses
US17/578,939 US20220241396A1 (en) 2019-01-23 2022-01-19 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/749,910 Continuation US11241492B2 (en) 2019-01-23 2020-01-22 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20220241396A1 true US20220241396A1 (en) 2022-08-04

Family

ID=71069917

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/749,910 Active US11241492B2 (en) 2019-01-23 2020-01-22 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses
US17/578,939 Abandoned US20220241396A1 (en) 2019-01-23 2022-01-19 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/749,910 Active US11241492B2 (en) 2019-01-23 2020-01-22 Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses

Country Status (4)

Country Link
US (2) US11241492B2 (en)
EP (1) EP3914295A2 (en)
JP (2) JP2022527235A (en)
WO (1) WO2020167432A2 (en)

Cited By (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11802273B2 (en) 2014-06-20 2023-10-31 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Mutations that confer genetic stability to additional genes in influenza viruses
US11807872B2 (en) 2019-08-27 2023-11-07 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Recombinant influenza viruses with stabilized HA for replication in eggs
US11851648B2 (en) 2019-02-08 2023-12-26 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Humanized cell line

Families Citing this family (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2020167432A2 (en) 2019-01-23 2020-08-20 Yoshihiro Kawaoka Mutations that confer genetic stability to additional genes in influenza viruses
CN117098551A (en) * 2020-11-17 2023-11-21 维瓦尔第生物科学有限公司 Influenza virus encoding truncated NS1 protein and SARS-COV receptor binding domain

Family Cites Families (89)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4071618A (en) 1974-09-03 1978-01-31 Research Foundation For Microbial Diseases Of Osaka University Process for preparing virus disease live vaccines
JPS57136528A (en) 1981-02-09 1982-08-23 Hayashibara Biochem Lab Inc Preparation of viral vaccine
NZ219515A (en) 1987-02-10 1989-09-27 Wellcome Found Fusion proteins comprising influenza virus ha and a nonnatural antigenic epitope
US5840520A (en) 1989-08-28 1998-11-24 Aviron Recombinant negative strand RNA virus expression systems
US5166057A (en) 1989-08-28 1992-11-24 The Mount Sinai School Of Medicine Of The City University Of New York Recombinant negative strand rna virus expression-systems
US5854037A (en) 1989-08-28 1998-12-29 The Mount Sinai School Of Medicine Of The City University Of New York Recombinant negative strand RNA virus expression systems and vaccines
US5919676A (en) 1993-06-24 1999-07-06 Advec, Inc. Adenoviral vector system comprising Cre-loxP recombination
EP1394259A3 (en) 1994-07-18 2004-04-14 Karl-Klaus Prof. Dr. Conzelmann Recombinant infectious non-segmented negative strand RNA virus
US5716821A (en) 1994-09-30 1998-02-10 Uab Research Foundation Prevention and treatment of respiratory tract disease
WO1996010400A1 (en) 1994-09-30 1996-04-11 The Uab Research Foundation Gene therapy vectors and vaccines based on non-segmented negatives stranded rna viruses
AU3727895A (en) 1994-09-30 1996-04-26 St. Jude Children's Research Hospital Nucleic acid encoding mutant matrix proteins useful for attenuation or enhancement of influenza a virus
EP0780475B2 (en) 1995-08-09 2006-07-19 SCHWEIZ. SERUM- &amp; IMPFINSTITUT BERN Process for the production of infectious negative-strand RNA viruses
US6037348A (en) 1996-02-09 2000-03-14 Eli Lilly And Company Inhibition of viral replication
DE19612967A1 (en) 1996-04-01 1997-10-02 Behringwerke Ag Process for the propagation of influenza viruses in cell culture, and the influenza viruses obtainable by the process
DE19612966B4 (en) 1996-04-01 2009-12-10 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics Gmbh & Co. Kg MDCK cells and methods of propagating influenza viruses
US5994526A (en) 1996-06-21 1999-11-30 Plant Genetic Systems Gene expression in plants
AU3799797A (en) 1996-07-15 1998-02-09 Government Of The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary Of The Department Of Health And Human Services, The Production of attenuated respiratory syncytial virus vaccines from cloned nucleotide sequences
TW570803B (en) 1997-04-09 2004-01-11 Duphar Int Res Influenza vaccine
ATE501259T1 (en) 1997-05-23 2011-03-15 Us Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Dept Of Health And Human Services PRODUCTION OF ATTENUATE PARAINFLUENZA VIRUS VACCINES FROM CLONED NUCLEOTIDE SEQUENCES
CA2297786C (en) 1997-08-05 2011-06-14 Vlaams Interuniversitair Instituut Voor Biotechnologie New immunoprotective influenza antigen and its use in vaccination
US6169175B1 (en) 1997-08-06 2001-01-02 Centers For Disease Control And Prevention Preparation and use of recombinant influenza A virus M2 construct vaccines
KR100281676B1 (en) 1997-11-29 2001-04-02 신동권 New flu vaccine virus
US6544785B1 (en) 1998-09-14 2003-04-08 Mount Sinai School Of Medicine Of New York University Helper-free rescue of recombinant negative strand RNA viruses
US6146642A (en) 1998-09-14 2000-11-14 Mount Sinai School Of Medicine, Of The City University Of New York Recombinant new castle disease virus RNA expression systems and vaccines
EP1035209A1 (en) 1999-03-06 2000-09-13 ARTEMIS Pharmaceuticals GmbH Stable recombinant influenza viruses free of helper viruses
EP2345716B1 (en) 1999-04-06 2015-01-14 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Recombinant influenza viruses for vaccines and gene therapy
US8715940B2 (en) 1999-04-06 2014-05-06 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Method of making recombinant influenza virus
US6492169B1 (en) 1999-05-18 2002-12-10 Crucell Holland, B.V. Complementing cell lines
US6686168B1 (en) 1999-11-04 2004-02-03 Zymogenetics, Inc. Cell surface display of proteins by recombinant host cells
US7192759B1 (en) 1999-11-26 2007-03-20 Crucell Holland B.V. Production of vaccines
WO2001064846A1 (en) 2000-03-03 2001-09-07 Juridical Foundation The Chemo-Sero-Therapeutic Research Institute Cell usable in serum-free culture and suspension culture and process for producing virus for vaccine by using the cell
US6872395B2 (en) 2000-04-14 2005-03-29 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Viruses comprising mutant ion channel protein
PL205955B1 (en) 2000-04-28 2010-06-30 St Jude Childrens Res Hospital Dna transfection system for the generation of infectious influenza virus
EP1201760A1 (en) 2000-10-30 2002-05-02 ARTEMIS Pharmaceuticals GmbH Influenza virus vector for human dendritic cells
EP1233059A1 (en) 2001-02-09 2002-08-21 ARTEMIS Pharmaceuticals GmbH Influenza viruses with enhanced transcriptional and replicational capacities
EP1364006A2 (en) 2001-02-23 2003-11-26 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Methods to identify mutant cells with altered sialic acid
DE10144906B4 (en) 2001-09-12 2013-11-28 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics Gmbh Process for the large-scale production of vaccines
US6951752B2 (en) 2001-12-10 2005-10-04 Bexter Healthcare S.A. Method for large scale production of virus antigen
CN103540614B (en) 2002-02-13 2018-02-02 威斯康星旧生研究基金会 The signal of packaging of influenza virus vectors
WO2003076462A1 (en) 2002-03-08 2003-09-18 Crucell Holland B.V. Use of recombinant trypsin for vaccine production
CN1678345A (en) 2002-04-26 2005-10-05 米迪缪尼疫苗股份有限公司 Multi plasmid system for the production of influenza virus
US7465456B2 (en) 2002-04-26 2008-12-16 Medimmune, Llc Multi plasmid system for the production of influenza virus
DK2287288T3 (en) 2002-07-09 2013-01-07 Baxter Int Medium free of animal protein for cell culture
NZ542935A (en) 2003-04-23 2008-08-29 Wisconsin Alumni Res Found Recombinant influenza viruses holding a mutation in a transmembrane protein gene
US8475806B2 (en) 2003-05-28 2013-07-02 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation High titer recombinant influenza viruses for vaccines and gene therapy
JP2006525815A (en) 2003-05-28 2006-11-16 ウィスコンシン・アラムナイ・リサーチ・ファウンデイション Recombinant influenza vector with POLII promoter and ribozyme
WO2005018539A2 (en) 2003-06-16 2005-03-03 Medimmune Vaccines, Inc. Influenza hemagglutinin and neuraminidase variants
US7037707B2 (en) 2003-09-04 2006-05-02 St. Jude Children's Research Hospital Method for generating influenza viruses and vaccines
CA2551489C (en) 2003-12-23 2013-09-03 Gregory Duke Multi plasmid system for the production of influenza virus
JP2005245302A (en) 2004-03-04 2005-09-15 Kanazawa Univ Tlo Inc Recombinant influenza virus and vaccine using the same
CA2566858A1 (en) 2004-05-20 2005-12-01 Id Biomedical Corporation Process for the production of an influenza vaccine
ATE489965T1 (en) 2004-09-09 2010-12-15 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostic REDUCING POTENTIAL IATROGENIC RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH INFLUENZA VACCINES
CN101103103A (en) 2004-11-19 2008-01-09 威斯康星旧生研究基金会 Recombinant influenza vectors with tandem transcription units
CA2592120A1 (en) 2004-12-23 2006-07-06 Medimmune Vaccines, Inc. Non-tumorigenic mdck cell line for propagating viruses
JP5620048B2 (en) 2004-12-24 2014-11-05 アボツト・バイオロジカルズ・ベー・ブイAbbott Biologicals B.V. Influenza virus rescue
EP2441471B1 (en) 2005-03-08 2014-10-08 MedImmune, LLC Reassortant influenza viruses
CA2626266C (en) 2005-10-17 2015-09-08 Medimmune, Llc Multi plasmid system for the production of influenza virus
ES2619160T7 (en) 2006-01-27 2020-07-29 Seqirus Uk Ltd Flu vaccines containing hemagglutinin and matrix proteins
AU2012204138B2 (en) 2006-03-31 2014-02-06 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation High titer recombinant influenza viruses for vaccines
EP2010557B1 (en) 2006-03-31 2014-02-26 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation High titer recombinant influenza viruses for vaccines
AU2014202470B2 (en) 2006-03-31 2016-08-04 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation High titer recombinant influenza viruses for vaccines
US7883844B2 (en) 2006-05-11 2011-02-08 Juridical Foundation The Chemosero-Therapeutic Research Institute Method for propagating influenza virus
US7507411B2 (en) 2006-06-23 2009-03-24 University Of Saskatchewan Attenuated influenza NS1 variants
KR101586971B1 (en) 2006-08-09 2016-02-22 메디뮨 엘엘씨 Influenza hemagglutinin and neuraminidase variants
JP5260525B2 (en) 2006-09-15 2013-08-14 メディミューン,エルエルシー MDCK cell line supporting virus growth to high titer and bioreactor process using the same
EA200900784A1 (en) 2006-12-06 2009-12-30 Новартис Аг VACCINES INCLUDING ANTIGENS FROM FOUR STRAINS OF THE INFLUENZA VIRUS
US9474798B2 (en) 2007-06-18 2016-10-25 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Influenza M2 protein mutant viruses as live influenza attenuated vaccines
WO2008157583A1 (en) 2007-06-18 2008-12-24 Medimmune, Llc Influenza b viruses having alterations in the hemaglutinin polypeptide
PL2185191T3 (en) 2007-06-27 2013-02-28 Novartis Ag Low-additive influenza vaccines
WO2009014919A2 (en) * 2007-07-13 2009-01-29 Iowa State University Research Foundation, Inc. H2n3 influenza a viruses and methods of use
CN102149405A (en) 2008-07-11 2011-08-10 米迪缪尼股份有限公司 Influenza hemagglutinin and neuraminidase variants
AP3140A (en) 2009-07-16 2015-02-28 Crucell Holland Bv Production of polio virus at high titers for vaccine production
US9109013B2 (en) 2009-10-26 2015-08-18 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation High titer recombinant influenza viruses with enhanced replication in vero cells
GB0919117D0 (en) 2009-10-30 2009-12-16 Glaxosmithkline Biolog Sa Process
CA2780767A1 (en) * 2009-11-20 2011-05-26 Danisco Us Inc. Beta-glucosidase i variants with improved properties
US10130697B2 (en) 2010-03-23 2018-11-20 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Vaccines comprising mutant attenuated influenza viruses
GB201011502D0 (en) 2010-07-08 2010-08-25 Glaxosmithkline Biolog Sa Novel process
WO2012033236A1 (en) 2010-09-06 2012-03-15 에스케이케미칼 주식회사 Mdck cell line adapted to serum-free culture and suspension culture, and method for preparing viruses for vaccine using cells thereof
KR102628482B1 (en) 2011-06-24 2024-01-23 플루젠, 인코퍼레이티드 Influenza virus mutants and uses therefor
CN102304495A (en) 2011-09-08 2012-01-04 中国农业科学院上海兽医研究所 Recombinant influenza virus capable of expressing HA (hemagglutinin) protein with high efficiency and preparation method and application thereof
US8877560B2 (en) 2012-07-17 2014-11-04 Lite-On Technology Corp. Method for assembling heat generating element and heat dissipating element, pressure sensitive element, and power supplying unit
EP3004332A2 (en) 2013-06-06 2016-04-13 Novartis AG Influenza virus reassortment
WO2015009743A1 (en) 2013-07-15 2015-01-22 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation High titer recombinant influenza viruses with enhanced replication in mdck or vero cells or eggs
US10053671B2 (en) 2014-06-20 2018-08-21 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Mutations that confer genetic stability to additional genes in influenza viruses
US10633422B2 (en) 2015-06-01 2020-04-28 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Influenza virus replication by inhibiting microRNA lec7C binding to influenza viral cRNA and mRNA
WO2017007839A1 (en) 2015-07-06 2017-01-12 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Improved influenza virus replication for vaccine development
US11197925B2 (en) 2016-02-19 2021-12-14 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Influenza B virus replication for vaccine development
JP2018064493A (en) * 2016-10-19 2018-04-26 京都府公立大学法人 Proliferation method of influenza virus using mdck cells
WO2020167432A2 (en) 2019-01-23 2020-08-20 Yoshihiro Kawaoka Mutations that confer genetic stability to additional genes in influenza viruses

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
NONE CITED. *

Cited By (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11802273B2 (en) 2014-06-20 2023-10-31 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Mutations that confer genetic stability to additional genes in influenza viruses
US11851648B2 (en) 2019-02-08 2023-12-26 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Humanized cell line
US11807872B2 (en) 2019-08-27 2023-11-07 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation (Warf) Recombinant influenza viruses with stabilized HA for replication in eggs

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
EP3914295A2 (en) 2021-12-01
JP2024028825A (en) 2024-03-05
US11241492B2 (en) 2022-02-08
JP2022527235A (en) 2022-06-01
WO2020167432A3 (en) 2020-12-10
WO2020167432A2 (en) 2020-08-20
US20200237899A1 (en) 2020-07-30

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US11802273B2 (en) Mutations that confer genetic stability to additional genes in influenza viruses
US11241492B2 (en) Mutations that confer genetic stability to genes in influenza viruses
US20220202926A1 (en) Influenza b virus replication for vaccine development
EP2493912B1 (en) High titer recombinant influenza viruses with enhanced replication in vero cells
ES2655051T3 (en) Influenza virus with mutant PB2 gene segment as live attenuated vaccines
US8597661B2 (en) Neuraminidase-deficient live influenza vaccines
JP2023511444A (en) Recombinant influenza virus with stabilized NA
EP3700562A1 (en) Recombinant influenza viruses with stabilized ha for replication in eggs
US8507247B2 (en) Influenza A virus with attenuating mutations in NS2 protein
US20230390383A1 (en) Replication incompetent influenza vaccine platform for foreign protein delivery
Sadler Evaluation of a single cycle influenza virus as a candidate vaccine
WO2023196945A2 (en) Recombinant newcastle disease virus expressing lassa virus gp or np, and uses thereof
WO2023196759A2 (en) Recombinant newcastle disease viruses and immunogenic compositions for use in immunizing against sars-cov-2 omicron variant
Pho Development of a novel therapeutic against coronaviruses
WO2022232052A1 (en) Chimeric newcastle disease virus expressing apmv hn and f proteins

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: WISCONSIN ALUMNI RESEARCH FOUNDATION, WISCONSIN

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:KAWAOKA, YOSHIHIRO;FURUSAWA, YURI;SIGNING DATES FROM 20211020 TO 20211125;REEL/FRAME:058808/0578

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION